Analytical Geometry 2D and 3D - P R Vittal
Analytical Geometry 2D and 3D - P R Vittal
Analytical Geometry 2D and 3D - P R Vittal
II
ANALYTICAL GEOMETRY
2D AND 3D
P. R. Vittal
Visiting Professor
Department of Statistics
University of Madras
Chennai
Chennai Delhi
III
Brief Contents
About the Author
Preface
1 Coordinate Geometry
2 The Straight Line
3 Pair of Straight Lines
4 Circle
5 System of Circles
6 Parabola
7 Ellipse
8 Hyperbola
9 Polar Coordinates
10 Tracing of Curves
11 Three Dimension
12 Plane
13 Straight Line
14 Sphere
15 Cone
16 Cylinder
IV
Contents
About the Author
Preface
1 Coordinate Geometry
1.1 Introduction
1.2 Section Formula
Illustrative Examples
Exercises
2 The Straight Line
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Slope of a Straight Line
2.3 Slope-intercept Form of a Straight Line
2.4 Intercept Form
2.5 Slope-point Form
2.6 Two Points Form
2.7 Normal Form
2.8 Parametric Form and Distance Form
2.9 Perpendicular Distance on a Straight Line
2.10 Intersection of Two Straight Lines
2.11 Concurrent Straight Lines
2.12 Angle between Two Straight Lines
2.13 Equations of Bisectors of the Angle between Two Lines
Illustrative Examples
Exercises
3 Pair of Straight Lines
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Homogeneous Equation of Second Degree in x and y
3.3 Angle between the Lines Represented by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0
3.4 Equation for the Bisector of the Angles between the Lines Given
by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0
3.5 Condition for General Equation of a Second Degree Equation to
Represent a Pair of Straight Lines
Illustrative Examples
Exercises
4 Circle
4.1 Introduction
4.2 Equation of a Circle whose Centre is (h, k) and Radius r
4.3 Centre and Radius of a Circle Represented by the Equation x2 + y2 +
2gx + 2fy + c = 0
4.4 Length of Tangent from Point P(x1, y1) to the Circle x2 + y2 + 2gx +
2fy + c = 0
4.5 Equation of Tangent at (x1, y1) to the Circle x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c =
0
4.6 Equation of Circle with the Line Joining Points A (x1, y1)
and B (x2, y2) as the ends of Diameter
4.7 Condition for the Straight Line y = mx + c to be a Tangent to the
Circle x2 + y2 = a2
4.8 Equation of the Chord of Contact of Tangents from (x1, y1) to the
Circle x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
VI
4.9 Two Tangents can Always be Drawn from a Given Point to a Circle
and the Locus of the Point of Intersection of Perpendicular Tangents is
a Circle
4.10 Pole and Polar
4.11 Conjugate Lines
4.12 Equation of a Chord of Circle x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 in Terms
of its Middle Point
4.13 Combined Equation of a Pair of Tangents from (x1, y1) to the
Circle x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
4.14 Parametric Form of a Circle
Illustrative Examples
Exercises
5 System of Circles
5.1 Radical Axis of Two Circles
5.2 Orthogonal Circles
5.3 Coaxal System
5.4 Limiting Points
5.5 Examples (Radical Axis)
5.6 Examples (Limiting Points)
Exercises
6 Parabola
6.1 Introduction
6.2 General Equation of a Conic
6.3 Equation of a Parabola
6.4 Length of Latus Rectum
VII
VIII
IX
10 Tracing of Curves
10.1 General Equation of the Second Degree and Tracing of a Conic
10.2 Shift of Origin without Changing the Direction of Axes
10.3 Rotation of Axes without Changing the Origin
10.4 Removal of XY-term
10.5 Invariants
10.6 Conditions for the General Equation of the Second Degree to
Represent a Conic
10.7 Centre of the Conic Given by the General Equation of the Second
Degree
10.8 Equation of the Conic Referred to the Centre as Origin
10.9 Length and Position of the Axes of the Central Conic whose
Equation is ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 1
10.10 Axis and Vertex of the Parabola whose Equation is ax2 +
2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
Exercises
11 Three Dimension
11.1 Rectangular Coordinate Axes
11.2 Formula for Distance between Two Points
11.3 Centroid of Triangle
11.4 Centroid of Tetrahedron
11.5 Direction Cosines
Illustrative Examples
Exercises
12 Plane
XI
12.1 Introduction
12.2 General Equation of a Plane
12.3 General Equation of a Plane Passing Through a Given Point
12.4 Equation of a Plane in Intercept Form
12.5 Equation of a Plane in Normal Form
12.6 Angle between Two Planes
12.7 Perpendicular Distance from a Point on a Plane
12.8 Plane Passing Through Three Given Points
12.9 To Find the Ratio in which the Plane Joining the Points (x1, y1, z1)
and (x2, y2, z2) is Divided by the Plane ax + by + cz + d = 0.
12.10 Plane Passing Through the Intersection of Two Given Planes
12.11 Equation of the Planes which Bisect the Angle between Two Given
Planes
12.12 Condition for the Homogenous Equation of the Second Degree to
Represent a Pair of Planes
Illustrative Examples
Exercises
13 Straight Line
13.1 Introduction
13.2 Equation of a Straight Line in Symmetrical Form
13.3 Equations of a Straight Line Passing Through the Two Given
Points
13.4 Equations of a Straight Line Determined by a Pair of Planes in
Symmetrical Form
13.5 Angle between a Plane and a Line
XII
XIII
XIV
XV
To my grandchildren
Aarav and Advay
XVI
Preface
A successful course in analytical geometry must provide a foundation for
future work in mathematics. Our teaching responsibilities are to instil
certain technical competence in our students in this discipline of
mathematics. A good textbook, as with a good teacher, should accomplish
these aims. In this book, you will find a crisp, mathematically precise
presentation that will allow you to easily understand and grasp the
contents.
This book contains both two-dimensional and three-dimensional analytical
geometry. In some of the fundamental results, vector treatment is also
given and therefrom the scalar form of the results has been deduced.
The first 10 chapters deal with two-dimensional analytical geometry.
In Chapter 1, all basic results are introduced. The concept of locus is well
explained. Using this idea, in Chapter 2, different forms for the equation of
a straight line are obtained; all the characteristics of a straight line are also
discussed. Chapter 3 deals with the equation of a pair of straight lines and
its properties. In Chapters 4 and 5, circle and system of circles, including
coaxial system and limiting points of a coaxial system, are analysed.
Chapters 6, 7 and 8 deal with the conic sectionsparabola, ellipse and
hyperbola. Apart from their properties such as focus and directrix, their
parametric equations are also explained. Special properties such as
conormal points of all conics are described in details. Conjugate diameters
in ellipse and hyperbola and asymptotes of a hyperbola and rectangular
hyperbola are also analysed with a number of examples. A general
treatment of conics and tracing of conics is also provided.
In Chapter 9, we describe polar coordinates, which are used to measure
distances for some special purposes. Chapter 10 examines the conditions
for the general equation of the second degree to represent the different
types of conics.
In Chapters 11 to 16, we study the three-dimensional analytical geometry.
The basic concepts, such as directional cosines, are introduced in Chapter
11. In Chapter 12, all forms of plane are analysed with the help of
examples. Chapter 13 introduces a straight line as an intersection of a pair
of planes. Different forms of a straight line are studied; especially, coplanar
XVII
lines and the shortest distance between two skew lines. Chapter 14 deals
with spheres and system of spheres. In Chapters 15 and 16, two special
types of conicoidscone and cylinderare discussed.
A number of illustrative examples and exercises for practice are given in all
these 16 chapters, to help the students understand the concepts in a better
manner.
I hope that this book will be very useful for undergraduate students and
engineering students who need to study analytical geometry as part of their
curriculum.
Chapter 1
Coordinate Geometry
1.1 INTRODUCTION
Let XOX and YOY be two fixed perpendicular lines in the plane of the
paper. The line OX is called the axis of X and OY the axis
of Y. OX and OY together are called the coordinate axes. The point O is
called the origin of the coordinate axes. Let P be a point in this plane.
Draw PM perpendicular to XOX. The distance OM is called the xcoordinate or abscissa and the distance MP is called the y-coordinate or
ordinate of the point P.
x-coordinate
y-coordinate
First
Second
Third
Fourth
Example 1.1.2
The distance between the points P(2, 5) and Q(4, 7) is
1.2.1 Coordinates of the Point that Divides the Line Joining Two Given Points in a
Given Ratio
Let the two given points be P(x1, y1) and Q(x2, y2).
Also
Let AA, BB and CC be the medians of the triangle. Then A, B, C are the
midpoints of the sides BC, CA and AB, respectively. The coordinates
of A are
We know that the medians of a triangle are
concurrent at the point G called the centroid and G divides each median in
the ratio 2:1. Considering the median AA, the coordinates of G are
1.2.4 Area of Triangle ABC with Vertices A(x1, y1), B(x2, y2) and C(x3, y3)
Let the vertices of triangle ABC be A(x1, y1), B(x2, y2) and C(x3, y3).
Note 1.2.4.1: The area is positive or negative depending upon the order in
which we take the points. Since scalar area is always taken to be a positive
quantity, we take
Note 1.2.4.2: If the vertices of the triangle are (0, 0), (x1, y1) and (x2, y2),
then
Note 1.2.4.3: If the area of the triangle is zero, i.e. = 0, then we note that
the points are collinear. Hence, the condition for the points (x1, y1), (x2, y2)
and (x3, y3) to be collinear is
Let ABCD be the quadrilateral with vertices A(x1, y1), B(x2, y2), C(x3, y3)
and D(x4, y4). Draw AP, BQ, CR and DS perpendiculars to the x-axis. Then,
Locus
When a point moves so as to satisfy some geometrical condition or
conditions, the path traced out by the point is called the locus of the point.
For example, if a point moves keeping a constant distance from a fixed
point, the locus of the moving point is called circle and the fixed distance is
called the radius of the circle. Moreover, if a point moves such that
its distance from two fixed points are equal, then the locus of the point is
the perpendicular bisector of the line joining the two fixed points.
If A and B are two fixed points and point P moves such that
then
the locus of P is a circle with AB as the diameter. It is possible to represent
the locus of a point by means of an equation.
Suppose a point P(x, y) moves such that its distance from two fixed
points A(2, 3) and B(5, 3) are equal. Then the geometrical law is PA = PB
PA2 = PB2
Example 1.1
Find the distance between the points (4, 7) and (2, 5).
Solution
Let P and Q be the points (4, 7) and (2, 5), respectively.
Example 1.2
Prove that the points (4, 3), (7, 1) and (9, 3) are the vertices of an isosceles
triangle.
Solution
Let A(4, 3), B(7, 1), C(9, 3) be the three given points.
Then
Since the sum of two sides is greater than the third, the points form a
triangle. Moreover, AB = AC = 5. Therefore, the triangle is an isosceles
triangle.
Example 1.3
Show that the points (6, 6), (2, 3) and (4, 7) are the vertices of a right
angled triangle.
Solution
Let A, B, C be the points (6, 6), (2, 3) and (4, 7), respectively.
Hence, the points are vertices of a right angled triangle. Also, BC = AC.
Therefore, it is a right angled isosceles triangle.
Example 1.5
10
Solution
Let A, B, C be the points (4, 4), (4, 4) and
, respectively.
Since the opposite sides of the quadrilateral ABCD are equal, the four
points form a parallelogram.
Example 1.7
11
Show that the points (2, 2), (8, 4), (5, 7) and (1, 1) are the vertices of a
rectangle taken in order.
Solution
A quadrilateral in which the opposite sides are equal and the diagonals are
equal is a rectangle. LetA(2, 2), B(8, 4), C(5, 7) and D(1, 1) be the four
given points.
Thus, the opposite sides are equal and the diagonals are also equal. Hence,
the four points form a rectangle.
Example 1.8
Prove that the points (3, 2), (5, 4), (3, 6) and (1, 4) taken in order form a
square.
Solution
A quadrilateral in which all sides are equal and diagonals are equal is a
square. Let A, B, C, D be the points (3, 2), (5, 4), (3, 6), (1, 4), respectively.
Thus, all sides are equal and also the diagonals are equal. Hence, the four
points form a square.
Example 1.9
Find the coordinates of the circumcentre of a triangle whose vertices
are A(3, 2), B(4, 3) and C(6, 5). Also, find the circumradius.
12
Solution
Let A(3, 2), B(4, 3), and C(6, 5) be the given points. Let S(x, y) be the
circumcenter of ABC. Then SA = SB = SC = circumradius. Now
units.
13
Show that the points (3, 7), (6, 5) and (15, 1) lie on a straight line.
Solution
Let A(3, 7), B(6, 5) and C(15, 1) be the three points. Then
Hence, P is the centre of the circle passing through the points A, B, C; its
radius is 5.
14
Example 1.12
If O is the origin and the coordinates of A and B are (x1, y1) and (x2, y2),
respectively, prove that OAOB cos = x1x2 + y1y2 where
Solution
By cosine formula
15
where a is the side of the equilateral triangle. If the vertices of the triangle
have integral coordinates, then is a rational number. However,
from (1.9) we infer that the area is
times a rational number. Hence, if the
vertices of a triangle have integral coordinates, it cannot be equilateral.
Example 1.15
If t1, t2 and t3 are distinct, then show that the
points
Solution
and
a 0 cannot be collinear.
16
since t1, t2 and t3 are distinct. Hence, the three given points cannot be
collinear.
Example 1.16
The vertices of a triangle ABC are (2, 3), (4, 7), (5, 2). Find the length of
the altitude through A.
Solution
The area of ABC is given by
We know that
Example 1.17
17
Solution
If r is the circumradius of ABC, SA = SB = SC = r, SA2 = r2
Then, the coordinates of A, B and C are (rcos, rsin), (rcos, rsin) and
(rcos, rsin). The centroid of the triangle
is
The orthocentre is
and the circumcentre is S(0,0). Geometrically we
know that H, G and S are collinear. Therefore, the slope of SG and GH are
equal.
Example 1.18
A line joining the two points A(2, 0) and B(3, 1) is rotated about A in the
anticlockwise direction through an angle of 15. If B goes to C in the new
position, find the coordinate of C.
Solution
18
Then
19
Example 1.20
Find the coordinates of the point that divides the line joining the points (2,
3) and (4, 7) (i) internally (ii) externally in the ratio 3:2.
Solution
Let R and R respectively divide PQ internally and externally in the ratio
3:2.
(i.e)
(16, 15)
Example 1.21
20
Find the ratio in which the line joining the points (4, 7) and (3, 2) is
divided by the y-axis.
Solution
Let the y-axis meet the line joining the joints P(4, 7) and Q(3, 2) at R. Let
the coordinates of R be (0, y). Let R divide PQ in the ratio k:1.
The coordinates of R is given by
Hence, the ratio in which R divides PQ is 4:3.
Example 1.22
Show that the points (2, 1), (1, 0), (4, 3) and (1, 2) form the vertices of a
parallelogram.
Solution
The midpoint of AC is
The midpoint of BD is
(i.e.) (1,1).
(i.e.) (1,1).
21
Solution
Let the four points be A, B, C and D, respectively. Since ABCD is a
parallelogram, the midpoint of AC is the same as the midpoint of BD.
The midpoint of AC is
4).
. The midpoint of BD is
(i.e) (6,
Let D, E and F be the midpoints of the sides BC, CA and AB, respectively.
Then, (6, 1), (1, 2), (1, 4) are the points D, E and F, respectively.
Let A(x1, y1), B(x2, y2) and C(x3, y3) be the vertices of the triangle.
Then BDEF is a parallelogram.
The midpoint of DF is
The midpoint of BE is
22
Hence, the vertices of the triangle are (6, 3), (8, 5) and (4, 7).
Example 1.25
Show that the axes of coordinates trisect the straight line joining the points
(2, 2) and (1, 4).
Solution
Let the line joining the points (2, 2) and (1, 4) meet x-axis and y-axis
at A and B, respectively. Let the coordinates of A and B be (x, 0) and (0, y),
respectively. Let A divide the line in the ratio k:1. Then the x-coordinate
of A is given by
k + 2 = 0 k = 2
Hence, A divides the line in the ratio 2:1.
Let B divide the line in the ratio l:1. Then,
23
Hence,
B divides the line in the ratio 1:2. Hence, A and B trisect the line joining the
points (2, 4) and (1, 4).
Example 1.26
The vertices of a triangle are A(3, 5), B(7, 9) and C(1, 3). Find the length
of the three medians of the triangle.
Solution
Let D, E and F be the midpoints of the sides of BC, CA and AB, respectively.
The coordinates of D are
of E are
7).
(i.e.) (2,
units.
Example 1.27
Two of the vertices of a triangle are (4, 7) and (1, 2) and the centroid is at
the origin. Find the third vertex.
Solution
Let the third vertex of the triangle be (x, y). Then
24
The midpoint of AC is
25
Let the point R(2, 1) divide the line joining the points P(1, 1) and Q(4, 5) in
the ratio k:1. Then
Example 1.31
Find the locus of the point that moves from the point (4, 3) keeping a
constant distance of 5 units from it.
Solution
26
Let C(4, 3) be the given point and P(x, y) be any point such that CP = 5.
Then
Example 1.32
The ends of a rod of length l move on two mutually perpendicular lines.
Show that the locus of the point on the rod that divides it in the ratio 1:2 is
9x2 + 36y2 = l2.
Solution
Let AB be a rod of length l whose ends A and B are on the coordinate axes.
Let the coordinates of Aand B be A(a, 0) and B(0, b). Let the point P(x1, y1)
divide AB in the ratio 1:2.
27
Solution
Let the two fixed points be A(al, 0) and B(0, al). Let P(x1, y1) be a moving
point such that PA + PB = 2a.
Given that
Then
28
Then
Hence, 2 + 2 = a2 + b2
29
Then
30
6. If the points
are collinear for three
distinct values a, b and c, then show that abc (bc + ca + ab) + 3(a + b + c) =
0.
7. Perpendicular straight lines are drawn through the fixed point C(a, a) to meet
the axes of x andy at A and B. An equilateral triangle is described with AB as
the base of the triangle. Prove that the equation of the locus of C is the
curve y2 = 3(x2 + a2).
8. The ends A and B of a straight line segment of constant length c slides upon the
fixed rectangular axes OX and OY, respectively. If the rectangle OAPB is
completed, then show that the locus of the foot of the perpendicular drawn
from P to AB is
.
9. The point A divides the line joining P(1, 5) and Q(3, 5) in the ratio k:1. Find
the two values of kfor which the area of the triangle ABC is equal to 2 units in
magnitude when the coordinates ofB and C are (1, 5) and (7, 2), respectively.
10. The line segment joining A(3, 0) and B(0, 2) is rotated about a point A in the
anticlockwise direction through an angle of 45 and thus B moves to C. If
point D be the reflection of C in they-axis, find the coordinates of D.
Ans.:
11. If (a, b), (h, k) and (p, q) be the coordinates of the circumcentre, the centroid
and the orthocentre of a triangle, prove that 3h = p + 2.
12. Prove that in a right angled triangle, the midpoint of the hypotenuse is
equidistant from its vertices.
13. If G is the centroid of a triangle ABC, then prove that 3(GA2 + GB2 + GC2)
= AB2 + BC2 + CA2.
14. Show that the line joining the midpoint of any two sides of a triangle is half of
the third side.
15. Prove that the line joining the midpoints of the opposite sides of a quadrilateral
and the line joining the midpoints of the diagonals are concurrent.
16. If 1 and 2 denote the area of the triangles whose vertices are (a, b), (b, c),
(c, a) and (bc a2,ca b2), (ca b2, ab c2) and (ab c2, bc a2), respectively,
then show that 2 = (a + b + c)21.
17. Prove that if two medians of a triangle are equal, the triangle is isosceles.
18. If a, b and c be the pth, qth and rth terms of a HP, then prove that the points
having coordinates (ab, r), (bc, p) and (ca, q) are collinear.
31
19. Prove that a point can be found that is at the same distance from each of the
four points
20. If (x1, y1) (x2, y2) (x3, y3) and (x4, y4) be the vertices of a parallelogram
and x1x3 + y1y3 = x2x1 +y2y1 then prove that the parallelogram is a rectangle.
21. In any ABC, prove that AB2 + AC2 = 2(AD2 + DC2) where D is the midpoint
of BC.
22. If G is the centroid of a triangle ABC and O be any other point, then prove that
23. Find the incentre of the triangle whose vertices are (20, 7), (36, 7) and (0,
8).
Ans.:
24. If A, B and C are the points (1, 5), (3, 1) and (5, 7), respectively, and D,
E and F are the midpoints of BC, CA and AB, respectively, prove that area of
ABC is four times that of DEF.
25. If D, E and F divide the sides BC, CA and AB of ABC in the same ratio, prove
that the centroid of ABC and DEF coincide.
26. A and B are the fixed points (a, 0) and (a, 0). Find the locus of the
point P that moves in a plane such that
27. If (xi, yi), i = 1, 2, 3 are the vertices of the ABC and a, b and c are the lengths of
the sides BC, CA and AB, respectively, show that the incentre of the
triangle ABC is
28. Show that the points (a, b), (0, 0), (a, b) and (a2, b2) are either collinear, the
vertices of a parallelogram or the vertices of a rectangle.
29. The coordinates of three points O, A and B are (0, 0), (0, 4) and (6, 0),
respectively. A point Pmoves so that the area of POA is always twice the area
of POB. Find the equation of the locus of P.
Ans.: x2 9y2 = 0
32
30. The four points A(x1, 0), B(x2, 0), C(x3, 0) and D(x4, 0) are such that x1, x2 are
the roots of the equation ax2 + 2hx + b = 0 and x3, x4 are the roots of the
equation a1x2 + 2h1x + b1 = 0. Show that the sum of the ratios in
which C and D divide AB is zero, provided ab1 + a1b = 2hh1.
31. If
then show that the triangle with vertices (xi, yi), i = 1, 2, 3
and (ai, bi), i = 1, 2, 3 are congruent.
32. The point (4, 1) undergoes the following three transformations successively:
0.
1.
2.
33
Chapter 2
The Straight Line
2.1 INTRODUCTION
In the previous chapter, we defined that the locus of a point is the path
traced out by a moving point according to some geometrical law. We know
that the locus of a point which moves in such a way that its distance from a
fixed point is always constant.
2.1.1 Determination of the General Equation of a Straight Line
Suppose the point P(x, y) moves such that P(x, y), A(4, 1), and B(2, 3)
x(4) y(2) + 14 = 0
34
On dividing by + 1, we get
35
Note 2.1.2.1:
1. Similarly, the equation of the line parallel to x-axis and at a distance k from it
is y = k.
2. The equation of x-axis is y = 0.
3. The equation of y-axis is x = 0.
2.2 SLOPE OF A STRAIGHT LINE
If a straight line makes an angle with the positive direction of x-axis then
tan is called the slope of the straight line and is denoted by m.
m = tan .
36
Let P(x, y) be any point on the straight line which makes an angle with xaxis.
, OB = c = y-intercept. Draw PL perpendicular to x-axis
and BN perpendicular to LP. Then,
. BN = OL = x.
37
NP = LP LN = LP OB = y c.
In NBP,
This equation is true for all positions of P on the straight line. Hence, this is
the equation of the required line.
2.4 INTERCEPT FORM
Let P(x, y) be any point on the straight line which meets x and y axes
at A and B, respectively. Let OA = a, OB = b, ON = x, and NP = y; NA = OA
ON = a x. Triangles PNA and BOA are similar.
Therefore,
. This result is true
for all positions of P on the straight line and hence this is the equation of
the required line.
2.5 SLOPE-POINT FORM
Find the equation of the straight line with slope m and passing
through the given point (x1, y1).
The equation of the straight line with a given slope m is
38
Here, c is unknown. This straight line passes through the point (x1, y1). The
point has to satisfy the equation y = mx + c.
y1 = mx1 + c. Substituting the value of c in equation (2.4), we get the
equation of the line as
Find the equation of the straight line passing through two given
points (x1, y1) and (x2,y2).
where, m is unknown. The slope of the straight line passing through the
points
39
Let a straight line make an angle with x-axis and A(x1, y1) be a point on the
line. Draw AL, PMperpendicular to x-axis and AQ perpendicular to PM.
Then,
40
Equations (2.7) and (2.8) represent the same line and, therefore,
identifying
we get
41
The equation of the line PQ is x cos + y sin = p. Since the point R(x1, y1)
lies on the line x1 cos + ysin p1 = 0.
p1 = x1 cos + y1 sin.
Note 2.9.1: The perpendicular distance from the origin on the line ax +
by +
2.10 INTERSECTION OF TWO STRAIGHT LINES
42
Let the line ax + by = c = 0 divide the line joining the points P(x1, y1)
and Q(x2, y2) in the ratio :1. Then, the coordinates of the point of
division R are
This point lies on the line ax + by + c = 0
Note 2.10.1:
1. If is positive then the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) lie on the opposite sides of the
line ax + by + c= 0.
2. If is negative then the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) lie on the same side of the
line ax + by + c = 0.
3. In other words, if the expressions ax1 + by1 + c and ax2 + by2 + c2 are of
opposite signs then the point (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) lie on the opposite sides of the
line ax + by + c = 0. If they are of the same sign then the points (x1, y1) and
(x2, y2) lie on the same side of the line ax + by + c = 0.
43
b1y + c1 = 0 and a2x + b2y + c2 = 0. Then (x1, y1) has to satisfy the two
equations:
This equation shows that the point x = x1 and y = y1 satisfies equation (2.9).
Hence the point (x1, y1) lies on the straight line given by the equation
(2.9), which is a line passing through the intersection of the
lines a1x + b1y + c1 = 0 and a2x + b2y + c2 = 0.
2.11 CONCURRENT STRAIGHT LINES
This is the required condition for the three given lines to be concurrent. The
44
Let be the angle between two straight lines, whose slopes are m1 and m2.
Let the two lines with slopes m1 and m2 make angles 1 and 2 with x-axis.
Then, m1 = tan 1, m2 = tan 2. Also, = 1 2
45
If the RHS is positive, then is the acute angle between the lines. If RHS is
negative, then is the obtuse angle between the lines.
Note 2.12.1: If the lines are parallel then = 0 and tan = tan 0 = 0.
Therefore,
1. If two lines are parallel then their slopes are equal.
2. If the two lines are perpendicular then the product of their slopes is 1.
2.13 EQUATIONS OF BISECTORS OF THE ANGLE BETWEEN TWO LINES
If c1 and c2 are positive, then the equations of the bisector containing the
origin is given by
46
If c1 and c2 are not positive then the equations of lines should be written in
such a way that c1 and c2are positive.
Note 2.13.1: We can easily observe that the two bisectors are at right
angles.
ILLUSTRATIVE EXAMPLES
Example 2.1
Find the equation of the straight line which is at a distance of 10 units
from x-axis.
Solution
47
Example 2.5
Find the equation of the straight line making an angle 135 with the positive
direction of x-axis and cutting of an intercept 5 on the y-axis.
Solution
48
Example 2.6
Find the equation of the straight line cutting off the intercepts 2 and 5 on
the axes.
Solution
The equation of the straight line is
. Here, a = 2 and b = 5.
or 5x 2y = 10.
Example 2.7
Find the equation of the straight line passing through the points (7, 3) and
cutting off equal intercepts on the axes.
Solution
Let the equation of the straight line be
(i.e.) x + y = a.
49
Let the line meet the x and y axes at A and B, respectively. Then the
coordinates of A and B are (a, 0) and (0, b). The midpoint of AB is
However, the midpoint is given as (2, 5).
Therefore,
a = 4 and b = 10.
(i.e.) 5x 2y = 20.
50
Example 2.9
Find the equation of the straight line of the portion of which between the
axes is divided by the point (4, 3) in the ratio 2:3.
Solution
Let the equation of the straight line be
Let this line meet the x and y axes at A and B, respectively. The coordinates
of A and B are (a, 0) and (0, b), respectively.
The coordinates of the point that divides AB in the ratio 2:3 are
(i.e.) 9x + 8y = 60.
Example 2.10
Find the equations to the straight lines each of which passes through the
point (3, 2) and intersect the x and y axes at A and B such that OA OB = 2.
51
Solution
and
Example 2.11
Show that the points A(l, 1), B(5, 9), and C(l, 6) are collinear.
52
Solution
The slope of AB is
Since the slopes of AB and BC are equal and B is the common point, the
points are collinear.
Example 2.12
Prove that the triangle whose vertices are (2, 5), (3, 4), and (7, 10) is a
right angled isosceles triangle. Find the equation of the hypotenuse.
Solution
Let the points be A (2, 5), B (3, 4), and C (7, 10).
AB2 = (2 3)2 + (5 + 4)2 = 25 + 81 = 106,
BC2 = (3 7)2 + (4 10)2 = 16 + 196 = 212.
AC2 = (2 7)2 + (5 10)2 = 81 + 25 = 106. Therefore, AB2 + AC2 =
BC2 and AB = AC. Hence, theABC is a right angled isosceles triangle.
The equation of the hypotenuse BC is
Example 2.13
Find the equation of the straight line which cuts off intercepts on the axes
equal in magnitude but opposite in sign and passing through the point (4,
7).
Solution
53
Let the equation of the straight line cutting off intercepts equal in
magnitude but opposite in sign be
(i.e.) x y = a.
Solution
Let the line 3x 2y + 5 = 0 divide the line joining the points A(6, 7)
and B(2, 3) in the ratio k:1. Then the coordinates of the point of division
are
we get
54
Given
Solving equations (2.22) and (2.23), we get the point of intersection of the
two lines.
On subtracting, we get 5y = 2
55
Example 2.17
Prove that for all values of the straight line x(2 + 3) + y(3 ) 5 2 =
0 passes through a fixed point. Find the coordinates of the fixed point.
Solution
x(2 + 3) + y(3 ) 5 2 = 0. This equation can be written in the form
56
Therefore, the point of intersection of straight lines (2.29) and (2.30) is (1,
1). The straight line (2.28)passes through the point (1, 1) for all values of .
Hence (2.28) passes through the fixed point (1, 1).
Example 2.18
Find the equation of the straight line passing through the intersection of the
lines 3x y = 5 and 2x + 3y = 7 and making an angle of 45 with the
positive direction of x-axis.
Solution
Solving the equations,
We get,
x = 2.
y = 1.
Hence (2, 1) is the point of intersection of the lines (2.31) and (2.32).
57
(i.e) x + y = a.
58
Example 2.21
Find the angle between the lines
Solution
The slope of the line
Therefore,
.
(i.e.) 1 = 60. The slope the
line
Therefore,
between the lines is 1 2 = 30.
. The angle
Example 2.22
Find the equation of the perpendicular bisector of the line joining the
points (2, 6) and (4, 6).
Solution
The slope of the line joining the points (2, 6) and (4, 6)
is
59
Example 2.24
The foot of the perpendicular from the point (1, 2) on a line is (3,4). Find
the equation of the line.
60
Solution
Let AB be the line and D(3, 4) be the foot of the perpendicular from C(1, 2)
The slope of the line CD is
Therefore, the slope of the line AB is .
The equation of the line AB is y y1 = m(x x1)
Example 2.25
Find the equation of the right bisector of the line joining the points (2, 3)
and (4, 5).
Solution
The right bisector is the perpendicular bisector of the line joining the points
(2, 3) and (4, 5). The midpoint of the line is
Therefore, the slope of the given line is
The slope of the right bisector is 1. The equation of the right bisector
is y y1 = m(x x1) y 4 = 1 (x 3) or y 4 = x + 3 or x + y = 7.
Example 2.26
61
Since,
62
Hence the equation of the parallel line through (2, 3) is y y1 = m(x x1)
Example 2.28
Find the equation of the line passing through the point (4, 5) and is
perpendicular to the line 7x + 2y = 15.
Solution
Example 2.29
Find the equation of the line through the intersection of 2x + y = 8 and 3x +
7 = 2y and parallel to 4x+ y = 11.
Solution
The point of intersection of the lines 2x + y = 8 and 3x + 7 = 2y is obtained
by solving the following two equations:
On adding, we get
63
Let O (x1, y1) be the image of O on the line AB. Then C is the midpoint
of OO. The slope of the lineOO is
The equation of the line OO is
Solving the equations
64
From (2.45), 9 + 4y = 17. Therefore, y = 2. Hence (3, 2) is the point of intersection of the lines (2.45)and (2.46). The slope of the line
Therefore, the slope of the perpendicular line is
7y 14 = 5x 15 or 5x 7y = 1.
Example 2.32
Find the orthocentre of the triangle whose vertices are (5, 2), (1, 2), and
(1, 4).
Solution
65
Slope of
Slope of
Therefore, slope of BE is
The equation of BE is
Solving the equations (2.47) and (2.48), we get the coordinates of the
orthocentre:
On adding 5x = 1 or x = .
From (2.47),
The orthocentre is
Example 2.33
66
The points (1, 3) and (5, 1) are two opposite vertices of a rectangle. The
other two vertices lie on the line y = 2x + c. Find c and the remaining two
vertices.
Solution
Let ABCD be the rectangle with A and C as the points with coordinates (1,
3) and (5, 1), respectively. In a rectangle the diagonals bisect each other.
The midpoint AC is
As this point lies on BD whose equation is y = 2x + c. We get 2 = 6 + c or c =
4. Therefore, the equation of the line BD is y = 2x 4.
Therefore, the coordinates of any point on this line is (x, 2x 4). If this is
the point B then AB2 + BC2= AC2.
are collinear
67
Example 2.35
A vertex of an equilateral triangle is at (2, 3) and the equation of the
opposite side is x + y = 2. Find the equations of the other sides.
Solution
and
68
Example 2.36
One diagonal of a square is the portion of the line
intercepted
between the axes. Find the equation of the other diagonal.
Solution
The slope of AB is
69
Example 2.37
If the vertices of ABC are (xi, yi) i = 1, 2, 3. Show that the equation of the
Since the
Example 2.38
If (x, y) is an arbitrary point on the internal bisector of vertical angle A of
ABC, where (xi, yi), i = 1, 2, 3 are the vertices of A, B, and C, respectively,
70
and a, b, and c are the length of the sides BC, CA, andAB, respectively,
prove that
Solution
In ABC, AD is the internal bisector of
. We know that
71
Example 2.39
Find the orthocentre of the triangle whose vertices are (a, 0), (0, b), and (0,
0).
Solution
Solution
The equation of the line passing through the intersection of the lines
72
perpendicular to BC,
73
74
the equation (2.54) is the line passing through B and D and represents the
equation of the diagonal BD.
Example 2.43
A line through the point A(5, 4) meets the lines x + 3y + 2 = 0, 2x + y + 4
= 0, and x y 5 = 0 at the points B, C, and D, respectively.
If
Solution
The equation of the line passing through the point (5, 4) is
Any point on the line is (rcos 5, rsin 4). The point meets the line x +
3y + 2 = 0 at B then AB =r (rcos 5) + 3 (rsin 4) + 2 = 0.
Given that
75
76
Example 2.46
77
Prove that the area of the triangle whose roots are Lr = arx + bry + cr (r = 1,
2, 3) is
Solution
Let Ar, Br, and Cr be the cofactors of ar, br, and cr in D. The point of
intersection of the lines a1x + b1y+ c1 = 0, a2x + b2y + c2 = 0
is
78
Example 2.47
A straight line L intersects the sides BC, CA, and AB of a triangle ABC in D,
E, and F, respectively. Show that
Solution
Let DEF be the straight line meeting BC, CA, and AB at D, E, and F,
respectively. Let the equations of the line DEF be lx + my + n = 0.
Similarly
Multiplying these three we get
79
Example 2.48
A straight line is such that the algebraic sum of perpendiculars drawn upon
it from any number of fixed points is zero. Show that the straight line
passes through a fixed point.
Solution
Let (x1, y1), (x2, y2),, (xn, yn), be n fixed points and ax + by + c = 0 be a
given line. The algebraic sum of the perpendiculars from (xi, yi), i = 1,
2,..., n to this line is zero.
80
81
Find the direction in which a straight line must be drawn through the point
(1, 4) so that its point of intersection with the line x + y + 5 = 0 may be at a
distance
units.
Solution
Let the equation of the line through the point (1, 4) be
Any point on this line is (r cos + 1, r sin + 4). If this point lies on the
line x + y + 5 = 0 then r cos + 1 + r sin + 4 + 5 = 0.
Ans.:
2. The line 3x + 2y = 24 meets y-axis at A and x-axis at B. The perpendicular
bisector of AB meets the line through (0, 1) parallel to x-axis at C. Find the
area ABC.
82
through A is
4. A ray of light is sent along the line x 2y 3 = 0. Upon reaching the line 3x
2y 5 = 0 the ray is reflected from it. Find the equation of the line containing
the reflected ray.
Ans.: 29x 2y 31 = 0
5. The extremities of the diagonals of a square are (1, 1) and (2, 1). Obtain the
equation of the other diagonal.
Ans.: 6x + 4y + 3 = 0
Ans.: x 7y + 13 = 0 and 7x + y 9 = 0
Ans.: x y = 0
Ans.: 2x + 2y +
=0
10. Find the locus of the foot of the perpendicular from the origin upon the line
joining the points (acos, bsin) and (asin, bcos) where a is a variable.
83
11. Show that the locus given by x + y = 0, (a - b)x + (a + b)y = 2ab and (a + b)x +
(a b)y = 2abform an isosceles triangle whose vertical angle
is
Ans.:
12. The sides of a quadrilateral have the equations, x + 2y = 3, x = 1, x 3y = 4,
and 5x + y + 12 = 0. Show that the diagonals of the quadrilateral are at right
angles.
13. Given n straight lines and a fixed point O. Through O a straight line is drawn
meeting these lines in the point A1, A2,,An and a point A such
that
Prove that the locus of the point A is a straight line.
14. Find the equation of the line joining the point (3, 5) to the point of intersection
of the lines 4x +y 1 = 0 and 7x 3y 35 = 0 and prove that the line is
equidistant from the origin and the points A, B, C, and D.
15. Find the equation of the line passing through the point (2, 3) and making
intercepts of length 2 units and between the lines.
Ans.: 3x + 4y 8 = 0 and x 2 = 0
Ans.: 2x + y = 4 and x 2y + 3 = 0
19. Find the orthocentre of a triangle formed by lines whose equations are x + y =
1, 2x + 8y = 6, and 4x y + 4 = 0.
Ans.:
20. The sides of a triangle are ur = x cos r + y sin r pr = 0, r = 1, 2, 3. Show that
its orthocentre is given by u1 cos(2 3) = u2 cos(3 1) = u3 cos(1 2).
84
21. Find the equation of straight lines passing through the point (2, 3) and having
an intercept of length 2 units between the straight lines 2x + 3y = 3 and
2x + y = 5.
Ans.: x = 2, 3x + 4y = 18
22. Let a line L has intercepts a and b on the coordinate axes. When the axes are
rotated through an angle, keeping the origin fixed, the same line L has
intercepts p and q. Obtain the relation between a, b, p, and q.
Ans.:
23. A line through the variable point A (k + 1, 2k) meets the line 7x + y 16 = 0,
5x y + 8 = 0, x 5y + 8 = 0 at B, C, and D, respectively. Prove that AC, AB,
and AD are in G.P.
24. Find the equation of the straight lines passing through (2, 7) and having an
intercept of length 3 between the straight lines 4x + 3y = 12 and 4x + 3y = 3.
25. A line is such that its segment between the straight lines 5x y 4 = 0 and
3x + 4y 4 = 0 is bisected at the point (1, 5). Obtain its equation.
Ans.: (4, 7)
28. A line intersects x-axis at A(7, 0) and y-axis at B(0, 5). A variable
line PQ which is perpendicular to AB intersects x-axis at P and y-axis at Q.
If AQ and BP intersect at R, then find the locus of R.
Ans.: x2 + y2 7x + 5y = 0
29. A rectangle PQRS has its side PQ parallel to the line y = mx and vertices P, Q,
and S on the linesy = a, x = b, and x = b, respectively. Find the locus of the
vertex R.
85
Ans.:
31. Show that the straight lines 7x 2y + 10 = 0, 7x + 2y 10 = 0, and y = 2 form
an isosceles triangle and find its area.
Ans.:y = a, 4x 3y + 3a = 0.
35. Find the locus of a point which moves such that the square of its distance from
the base of an isosceles triangle is equal to the rectangle under its distances
from the other sides.
Ans.:
36. Prove that the lines given by (b + c)x bcy = a(b2 + bc + c2),
(c + a)x cay = b(c2 + ca + a2), and (a + b)x aby = c(a2 + ab + b2) are
concurrent.
37. Show that the area of the triangle formed by the lines y = m1x + c1, y = m2x + c2,
and y = m3x +c3 is
38. Find the bisector of the acute angle between the lines 3x + 4y = 1 which is the
bisector containing the origin.
86
39. If a1a2 + b1b2 > 0 prove that the origin lies at the obtuse angle between the
lines a1x + b1y + c1 = 0 and a2x + b2y + c2 = 0, where c1 and c2 both being of the
same sign.
40. Find the equation to the diagonals of the parallelogram formed by the
lines ax + by + c = 0, ax+ by + d = 0, ax + by + c = 0, ax + by d = 0.
Show that the parallelogram will be a rhombus if (a2 + b2)(c d)2 =
(a2 + b2)(c d)2.
41. A variable line is at a constant distance p from the origin and meets coordinate
axes in A and B. Show that the locus of the centroid of the
OAB is x2 + y2 = p2.
42. A moving line is lx + my + n = 0 where l, m, and n are connected by the
relation al + bm + cn = 0, and a, b, and c are constants. Show that the line
passes through a fixed point.
43. Find the equation of bisector of acute angle between the lines 3x 4y + 7 = 0
and 12x + 5y 2 = 0.
44. Q is any point on the line x a = 0 and O is the origin. If A is the point (a, 0)
and QR, the bisector
meets x-axis on R. Show that the locus of the foot of
the perpendicular from R toOQ is the (x 2a) (x2 + y2 + a2x) = 0.
45. The lines ax + by + c = 0, bx + cy + a = 0, and cx + ay + b = 0 are concurrent
where a, b, and care the sides of the ABC in usual notation and prove that
sin3 A + sin3 B + sin3 C = 3sin A sinBsin C.
46. A variable straight line OPQ passes through the fixed point O, meeting the two
fixed lines in points P and Q. In the straight line OPQ, a point R is taken such
that OP, OR, and OQ are in harmonic progression. Show that the locus of
point Q is a straight line.
47. A ray of light is set along the line x 2y 3 = 0. On reaching the line 3x 2y
5 = 0, the ray is reflected from it. Find the equation of the line containing the
reflected ray 2qx 2y 31 = 0.
Ans.:2qx 2y 31 = 0.
48. Let ABC be a triangle with AB = AC. If D is the midpoint of BC, and E is the
foot of the perpendicular drawn from D to AC and F is the midpoint of BE.
Prove that AF is perpendicular to BE.
87
intercepted between
are
53. Show that the origin lies inside a triangle whose vertices are given by the
equations 7x 5y 11 = 0, 8x + 3y + 31 = 0, and x + 3y 19 = 0.
54. A ray of light travelling along the line OA, O being the origin, is reflected by the
line mirror x y+ 1 = 0, the point of incidence A is (1, 2). The reflected ray is
again reflected by the mirror x y= 1, the point of incidence being B. If the
reflected ray moves along BC, find the equation of BC.
Ans.: 2x y 6 = 0
55. If the lines p1x + q1y = 1, p2x + q2y = 1, and p3x + q3y = 1 are concurrent, prove
that the points (p1, q1), (p2, q2), and (p3, q3) are collinear.
56. If p, q, and r be the length of the perpendiculars from the vertices A, B,
and C of a triangle on any straight line, prove that a2 (p q)(p r) + b2 (q
r)(q p) + c2(r p)(r q) = 42.
57. Prove that the area of the parallelogram formed by the straight
line a1x + b1y + c1 = 0, a1x + b1y+ d1 = 0, a2x + b2y + c2 = 0, and a2x + b2y + d2 =
0 is
58. A ray of light is sent along the line 2x 3y = 5. After refracting across the
line x + y = 1, it enters the opposite sides after turning by 15 away from the
line x + y = 1. Find the equation of the line along which the refracted ray travels
Ans.: (15
20) x (30 10
) y + (11 18
) = 0.
Ans.: x 3y 31 = 0, 3x + y + 7 = 0.
88
60. Find all those points on the line x + y = 4 which are at c unit distance from the
line 4x + 3y = 10.
61. Are the points (3, 4) and (2, 6) on the same or opposite sides of the line 3x
4y = 8?
62. How many circles can be drawn each touching all the three lines x + y =
1, y = x, and 7x y = 6? Find the centre and radius of one of the circles.
89
Chapter 3
Pair of Straight Lines
3.1 INTRODUCTION
l1x1 + m1y + n1 = 0
This shows that (x1, y1) is also a point on the locus of (3.3). Therefore, every
point on the line given by(3.1) is also a point on the locus of (3.3). Similarly,
every point on the line given by (3.2) is also a point on the locus of (3.3).
Therefore, (3.3) satisfies all points on the straight lines given
by (3.1) and (3.2). Hence, we say (3.3) represents the combined equation of
the straight lines given by (3.1) and (3.2). It is possible to rewrite (3.3) as
The pair of straight lines given by (3.1) and (3.2) is in general represented
in the form (3.4). However, we cannot say that every equation of this form
90
will represent a pair of straight lines. We will find the condition that is
necessary and sufficient for the equation of the form (3.4) to represent a
pair of straight lines. Before that we will see that every second degree
homogeneous equation in x and y will represent a pair of straight lines.
3.2 HOMOGENEOUS EQUATION OF SECOND DEGREE IN X AND Y
Then
But y m1x = 0 and y m2x = 0 are straight lines passing through the
origin.
Therefore, ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 represents a pair of straight lines passing
through the origin.
Note 3.2.1: ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = b(y m1x) (y m2x)
Equating the coefficients of x2 and xy, we get
91
Let be the angle between the lines given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0. Then the
angle between the lines is given by
The positive sign gives the acute angle between the lines and the negative
sign gives the obtuse angle between them.
Note 3.3.1: If the lines are parallel or coincident, then = 0. Then tan =
0. Therefore, from (3.7), we get h2 = ab.
Note 3.1.3: If the lines are perpendicular then
and so we get
from (3.7)
This means a + b = 0. Hence, the condition for
the lines to be parallel or coincident is h2 = ab and the condition for the
lines to be perpendicular is a + b = 0 (i.e.) Coefficient of x2 + Coefficient
of y2 = 0.
3.4 EQUATION FOR THE BISECTOR OF THE ANGLES BETWEEN THE LINES GIVEN
BY AX2 + 2HXY + BY2 = 0
92
We will now derive the equation for the bisector of the angles between the
lines given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0. The combined equation of the bisectors
of the angles between the lines given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 is
93
We will now derive the condition for the general equation of a second
degree equation to represent a pair of straight lines. The condition for the
general equation of the second degree ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
to represent a pair of straight lines is abc + 2fgh af 2 bg2 ch2 = 0.
Method 1:
Consider the general equation of the second degree
94
We know that
95
Method 2:
Writing this equation in the form by2 + 2hxy + 2fy + (ax2 + 2gx + c) = 0 and
solving for y we get
This equation will represent two straight lines if the quadratic expression
under the radical sign is a perfect square. The condition for this is 4(hf
bg)2 4(h2 ab)(f 2 bc) = 0
Since b 0,
96
As (3.16) represents a pair of straight lines passing through the new origin,
it has to be a homogeneous equation in X and Y. Hence,
gx1 + fy1 + c = 0
(3.21)
97
lx + my = 1.
(3.23)
will meet at two points say P and Q. Let (x1, y1) be one of the points of
intersection, say P. Then
98
Example 3.1
The gradient of one of the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 is twice that of the
other. Show that 8h2 = 9ab.
Solution
The equation ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 represents a pair of straight lines passing
through the origin. Let the lines be y m1x = 0 and y m2x = 0. Then
99
Example 3.2
Prove that one of the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 will bisect an angle between
the coordinate axes if (a+ b)2 = 4h2.
Solution
Let y m1x = 0 and y m2x = 0 be the two lines represented by a2 +
2hxy + by2 = 0.
Then
Since one of the lines bisects the angle between the axes, we take m1 = 1.
Then
Example 3.3
Find the centroid of the triangle formed by the lines given by the equations
12x2 20xy + 7y2 = 0 and 2x 3y + 4 = 0.
Solution
100
The point of intersection of the lines (3.28) and (3.29) is (0, 0). Let us
solve (3.29) and (3.30).
Thus, the point of intersection of these two lines is (7, 6). Now, let us
solve (3.28) and (3.30).
Thus, the point of intersection of these two lines is (1, 2). Then, the centroid
of the triangle with vertices (0, 0), (7, 6) and (1, 2)
is
(i.e)
Example 3.4
Find the product of perpendiculars drawn from the point (x1, y1) on the
lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0.
101
Solution
Let the lines be y m1x = 0 and y m2x = 0. Then
Let p1 and p2 be the perpendicular distances from (x1, y1) on the two
lines y m1x = 0 and y m2x = 0, respectively.
Example 3.5
If the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 be the two sides of a parallelogram and the
line lx + my = 1 be one of the diagonals, show that the equation of the other
diagonal is y(bl hm)y = (am h)lx. Show that the parallelogram is a
rhombus if h(a2 b2) = (a h)lm.
Solution
102
103
Example 3.6
Prove that the area of the triangle formed by the lines y = x + c and the
straight lines
Solution
Let the two lines represented by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 be y m1x = 0
and y m2x = 0. Solving the equations y m1x = 0 and y = x + c, we get the
coordinates of A to be
Example 3.7
104
L and M are the feet of the perpendiculars from (c, 0) on the lines ax2 +
2hxy + by2 = 0. Show that the equation of the line LM is (a b)x +
2hy + bc = 0.
Solution
Both these equations represent the same lines. Therefore identifying these
equations, we get
105
Let OA and OB be the lines represented by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 and their
equations be y m1x = 0 and y m2x = 0.
The equation of the line AB is x cos + y sin = p. The coordinates
of A are
of B are
The midpoint (x1, y1) of AB is
The coordinates
106
Example 3.9
Find the condition that one of the lines given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 may
be perpendicular to one of the lines given by a1x2 + 2h1xy + by2 = 0.
Solution
Let y = mx be a line of ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0. Then
Then
Hence,
107
Two sides of a triangle lie along y2 m2x2 = 0 and its orthocentre is (c, d).
Show that the equation of its third side is (1 m2)(cx + dy) = c2 m2d2.
Solution
From (3.33),
108
Example 3.11
Show that the equation m(x3 3xy2) + y3 3x2 y = 0 represents three
straight lines equally inclined to one another.
Solution
These values of show that the lines are equally inclined to one another.
Example 3.12
Show that the straight lines (A2 3B2)x2 + 8ABx + (B2 3A2) = 0 form with
the line Ax + By + C = 0 an equilateral triangle of area
Solution
The sides of the triangle are given by
109
Example 3.13
Show that two of the straight lines ax3 + bx2 y + cxy2 + dy3 = 0 will be
perpendicular to each other ifa2 + d2 + bd + ac = 0.
Solution
110
Exercises
1. Show that the equation of pair of lines through the origin and perpendicular to
the pair of linesax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 is bx2 2hxy + ay2 = 0.
2. Through a point A on the x-axis, a straight line is drawn parallel to the y-axis so
as to meet the pair of straight lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 in B and C. If AB = BC,
prove that 8h2 = 9ab.
3. From a point A(1, 1), straight lines AL and AM are drawn at right angles to the
pair of straight lines 3x2 + 7xy 2y2 = 0. Find the equation of the pair of
lines AL and AM. Also find the area of the quadrilateral ALOM where O is the
origin of the coordinate.
111
4. Show that the area of the triangle formed by the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0
and lx + my = 1 is
5. Show that the orthocentre of the triangle formed by the lines ax2 +
2hxy + by2 = 0 and lx + my= 1 is given by
6. Show that the centroid (x1, y1) of the triangle formed by the lines ax2 +
2hxy + by2 = 0 and lx +my = 1 is
7. A triangle has the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 for two of its sides and the point
(c, d) for its orthocentre. Prove that the equation of the third side is (a + b)
(cx + dy) = ad2 2hbd + bc2.
8. If the slope of one of the lines given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 is k times the
other, prove that 4kh2= abc (1 + k)2.
9. If the distance of the point (x1, y1) from each of two straight lines through the
origin is d, prove that the equation of the straight lines is
(x1y xy1)2 = d2(x2 + y2).
10. A straight line of constant length 2l has its extremities one on each of the
straight lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0. Show that the line of midpoint is
(ax + by)2 (hx + by) + (ab h2)2l2a.
11. Prove that the triangle formed by the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 and lx + my = 1
is right angled if (a + b)/al2 + 2hlm + bm2) = 0.
12. Show that if two of the lines ax3 + bx2y + cxy2 + dy3 = 0 make complementary
angles with x-axis in anticlockwise direction, then a(a c) + d(b d) = 0.
13. If the slope of the lines given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 is the square of the other,
show that ab(a+ h) 6ahb + 8h3 = 0.
14. Show that the line ax + by + c = 0 and the two lines given by (ax + by)2 = 3(bx
ay)2 form an equilateral triangle of area
15. If one of the line given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 is common with one of the lines
of a1x2 + 2h1xy +b1y2 = 0. show that (ab1 a1b)2 + 4(ah1 a1h). (bh1 b1h) = 0.
16. A point moves so that its distance between the feet of the perpendiculars from
it on the lines ax2+ 2hxy + by2 = 0 is a constant 2k. Show that the locus of the
point is (x2 + y2)(h2 ab) = k2[(a b)2 + 4h2].
17. Show that the distance from the origin to the orthocentre of the triangle
formed by the lines
and ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 is
18. A parallelogram is formed by the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 and the lines
through (p, q) parallel to them. Show that the equation of the diagonal not
passing through the origin is (2x p)(ap + hq) + (2y q)(hp + bq) = 0.
19. If the lines given by lx + my = 1 and ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 form an isosceles
triangle, show thath(l2 m2) = lm(a b).
112
Example 3.14
Find so that the equation x2 + 5xy + 4y2 + 3x + 2y + = 0 represents a
pair of lines. Find also their point of intersection and the angle between
them.
Solution
Consider the second degree terms x2 + 5xy + 4y2.
and 3x + 12y +
113
Example 3.15
Find the value of so that the equation x2 10xy + 12y2 + 5x 16y 3 = 0
represents a pair of straight lines. Find also their point of intersection.
Solution
The condition for the given equation to represent a pair of straight lines
is abc + 2fgh af 2 bg2 ch2 = 0
36 + 200 64 75 + 75 = 0 = 2
114
Example 3.16
Find the value of so that the equation x2 xy + 2y2 + 3x 5y + 2= 0
represents a pair of straight lines.
Solution
Example 3.17
Prove that the general equation of the second degree ax2 + 2hxy + by2 +
2gx + 2fy + c = 0 represents parallel straight lines if h2 = ab and bg2 = af 2.
Prove that the distance between the two straight lines is
Solution
Let the parallel lines be lx + my + n = 0 and lx + my + n1 = 0.
Then ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = (lx + my + n) (lx + my + n1)
Equating the like terms, we get
115
Example 3.18
If ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 represents two straight lines
equidistant from the origin, show that f 4 g4 = c(bf 2 ag2).
Solution
Let the two lines represented by the given equation be lx + my + n = 0
and l1x + m1y + n1 = 0. Then
Perpendicular distances from the origin to the two lines are equal.
Therefore,
Squaring
Example 3.19
116
If the equation ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 represents
two straight lines, prove that the product of the lengths of the
perpendiculars from the origin on the straight lines is
Solution
Let the two lines be lx + my + n = 0 and l1x + my + n = 0. Therefore
Example 3.20
If ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 represents two straight
lines, prove that the square of the distance of their point of intersection
from the origin is
Further, if the two given lines are
perpendicular, then prove that the distance of their point of intersection
from the origin is
Solution
Let the two straight lines be lx + my + n = 0 and l1x + m1y + n1 = 0.
Their point of intersection is
117
Example 3.21
Show that the lines given by 12x2 + 7xy 12y2 = 0 and 12x2 + 7xy
12y2 x + 7y 1 = 0 are along the sides of a square.
Solution
The second degree terms in (3.42) and (3.43) are the same. This implies
that the two lines represented by (3.42) are parallel to the two lines
represented by (3.43). Hence, these four lines from a parallelogram. Also,
in each of the equations coefficient of x2 + coefficient of y2 = 0.
Hence, each equation forms a pair of perpendicular lines. Thus, the four
lines form a rectangle. The two lines represented by (3.42) are 3x + 4y = 0
and 4x 3y = 0. The two lines represented by (3.43)are 3x + 4y 1 = 0 and
4x 3y + 1 = 0.
The perpendicular distance between 2x + 4y = 0 and 3x + 4y 1 = 0 is .
The perpendicular distance between 4x 3y = 0 and 4x 3y + 1 = 0 is .
118
Ans.: 2x + 3y + 4 = 0
3x + 4y + 5 = 0
2. Prove that the equations 8x2 + 8xy + 2y2 + 26x + 13y + 15 = 0 represents two
parallel straight lines and find the distance between them.
Ans.:
3. Prove that the equation 3x2 + 8xy 7y2 + 21x 3y + 18 = 0 represents two
lines. Find their point of intersection and the angle between them.
Ans.:
4. If ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 and ax2 + 2hxy + by2 2gx 2fy + c = 0
each represents a pair of lines, prove that the area of the parallelogram
enclosed is
5. Show that the equation 3x2 + 10xy + 8y2 + 14x 22y + 15 = 0 represents two
straight lines intersecting at an angle
6. The equation ax2 2xy 2y2 5x + 5y + c = 0 represents two straight lines
perpendicular to each other. Find a and c.
Ans.: a = 2, c = 3
7. Find the distance between the parallel lines given by 4x2 + 12xy + 9y2 6x
9y + 1 = 0.
Ans.:
8. Show that the four lines 2x2 + 3xy 2y2 = 0 and 2x2 + 3xy 2y2 3x + y + 1 =
0 form a square.
119
9. Show that the straight lines represented by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 and those
represented by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 form a rhombus, if
(c h) fg + h(f 2 g2) = 0.
10. If the equation ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 represents two straight
lines and parallel lines to these two lines are drawn through the origin then
show that the area of the parallelogram so formed is
11. If the straight lines given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 intersects on
the y-axis then show that 2fgh hg2 ch2 = 0.
12. A parallelogram is such that two of its adjacent sides are along the lines ax2 +
2hxy + by2 = 0 and its centre is (a, b). Find the equation of the other two sides.
which is (3.45).
The combined equation of the bisectors of the angle between lines given
by (3.45) is
120
which is (3.44). Hence, each pair bisects the angle between the other.
Example 3.23
If the bisectors of the line x2 2pxy y2 = 0 are x2 2qxy y2 = 0 show
that pq + 1 = 0.
Solution
x2 2qxy y2 = 0
(3.47)
pq + 1 = 0
Example 3.24
Prove that if one of the lines given by the equation ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0
bisects the angle between the coordinate axes then (a + b)2 = 4h2.
121
Solution
The bisectors of the coordinate axes are given by y = x and y = x. If y = x is
one of the lines of ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 then ax2 + 2hx2 + bx2 = 0.
(i.e.) a + b = 2h
Example 3.26
Show that the pair of the lines given by a2x2 + 2h(a + b)xy + b2y2 = 0 is
equally inclined to the pair given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0.
Solution
In order to show that the pair of lines given by a2x2 + 2h(a + b)xy + b2y2 = 0
is equally inclined to the pair of lines given by ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0, we have
122
to show that both the pairs have the same bisectors. The combined
equations of the bisectors of the first pair of lines
is
pair of lines.
Exercises
1. If the pair of lines x2 2axy y2 = 0 bisects the angles between the lines x2
2pxy y2 = 0 then show that the latter pair also bisects the angle between the
former pair.
2. If one of the bisectors of ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 passes through the point of
intersection of the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 then show
that h(f 2 g2) + (a b) fg = 0.
3. If the pair of straight lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 and bx2 + 2gxy + by2 = 0 be
such that each bisects the angle between the other then prove that hg b = 0.
4. Prove that the equations 6x2 + xy 12y2 14x + 47y 40 = 0 and 14x2 + xy
4y2 30x + 15y= 0 represent two pairs of lines such that the lines of the first
pair are equally inclined to those of the second pair.
5. Prove that two of the lines represented by the
equation ax4 + bx2y + cx2y2 + dxy3 + ay4 = 0 will bisect the angle between the
other two if c + ba = 0 and b + d = 0.
Example 3.27
If the straight lines joining the origin to the point of intersection of
3x2 xy + 3y2 + 2x 3y + 4 = 0 and 2x + 3y = k are at right angles, prove
that 6k2 5k + 52 = 0.
Solution
Let
The combined equation of the lines joining the origin to the point of
intersection of the lines given(3.48) and (3.49) is got by
homogenising (3.48) with the help of (3.49). Hence, the combined equation
of the lines joining the origin to the points of intersection of
(3.48) and (3.49) is
123
Example 3.28
Show that the pair of straight lines joining the origin to the point of
intersection of the straight linesy = mx + c and the circle x2 + y2 = a2 are at
right angles 2c2 = a2(1 + m2).
Solution
It is given that x2 + y2 = a2 and y = mx + c.
124
Let equation (3.50) represents the lines CA and CB and (3.51) represents
the line AB.
The combined equation of the lines OA and OB is got by
homogeniousing (3.50) with the help of(3.51).
Since the second degree terms in (3.50) and (3.52) are the same the two
lines represented by (3.50)are parallel to the two lines represented
by (3.52). Therefore, the four lines form a parallelogram.
Example 3.30
125
Then
Example 3.31
Find the equation to the straight lines joining the origin to the point of
intersection of the straight line
and the circle 5(x2 + y2 + ax + by) =
9ab and find the conditions that the straight lines may be at right angles.
Solution
It is given that,
126
The combined equation of the lines joining the origin to the points of
intersection of (3.53) and (3.54)is
Example 3.32
The line lx + my = 1 meets the circle x2 + y2 = a2 in P and Q. If O is the origin
then show that
Solution
The perpendicular from the origin to the
line
OP = a
127
Example 3.33
The straight line y k = m(x + 2a) intersects the curve y2 = 4a (x + a)
in A and C. Show that the bisectors of angle
, O being the origin, are
the same for all values of m.
Solution
Let
Example 3.34
Prove that if all chords of ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 subtend a
right angle at the origin, then the equation must represent two straight
lines at right angles through the origin.
128
Solution
lx + my = 1
(3.56)
Let the lines (3.55) and (3.56) intersect at P and Q. The combined equation
of OP and OQ is ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + (2gx + 2fy) (lx + my) + c(lx + my)2 = 0.
Since
, coefficient of x2 + coefficient of y2 = 0.
Since l and m are arbitrary, coefficients of l1, l2, m1, m2 and the constant term
vanish separately. Sinceg = 0, f = 0, c = 0 and a + b = 0.
Hence, equation (3.55) becomes ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 which is a pair of
perpendicular lines through the origin.
Exercises
1. Show that the line joining the origin to the points common to 3x2 + 5xy + 3y2 +
2x + 3y = 0 and 3x 2y = 1 are at right angles.
2. If the straight lines joining the origin to the point of intersection 3x2 xy +
3y2 + 2x 3y + 4 = 0 and 2x + 3y = k are at right angles then show that 6k2
5k + 52 = 0.
3. Show that all the chords of the curve 3x2 y2 2x + y = 0 which subtend a
right angle at the origin pass through a fixed point.
4. If the curve x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 intercepts on the line lx + my = 1, which
subtends a right angle at the origin then show that a(l2 + m2) + 2(gl + fm + 1) =
0.
129
5. If the straight lines joining the origin to the point of intersection of the
line kx + hy = 2hk with the curve (x h)2 + (y k)2 = a2 are at right angles at
the origin show that h2 + k2 = a2.
6. Prove that the triangle formed by the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = 0 and lx + my = 1
is isosceles if (l2 m2)h = (a b)lm.
7. Prove that the pair of lines joining the origin to the intersection of the
curves
by the line lx + my + n = 0 are coincident if a2l2 + b2m2 = n2.
8. Show that the straight lines joining the origin to the point of intersection of the
curves ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx = 0 and a1x2 + 2h1xy + b1y2 + 2g1x = 0 will be at
right angles if g1(a1 + b1) =g(h1 + b1).
9. Show that the angle between the lines drawn from the origin to the point of
intersection of x2 + 2xy + y2 + 2x + 2y 5 = 0 and 3x y + 1 = 0 is
130
Chapter 4
Circle
4.1 INTRODUCTION
Definition 4.1.1: A circle is the locus of a point in a plane such that its
distance from a fixed point in the plane is a constant. The fixed point is
called the centre of the circle and the constant distance is called the radius
of the circle.
4.2 EQUATION OF A CIRCLE WHOSE CENTRE IS (H, K) AND RADIUS R
Let C (h, k) be the centre of the circle and P (x, y) be any point on the
circle. CP = r is the radius of the circle. CP2 = r2 (i.e.) (x h)2 + (y k)2 = r2.
This is the equation of the required circle.
Note 4.2.1: If the centre of the circle is at the origin, then the equation of
the circle is x2 + y2 = r2.
4.3 CENTRE AND RADIUS OF A CIRCLE REPRESENTED BY THE EQUATION X2 + Y2 +
2GX + 2FY + C = 0
131
This equation is of the form (x h)2 + (y k)2 = r2, which is a circle with
centre (h, k) and radius r.Thus, equation (4.1) represents a circle whose
centre is (g, f) and radius
Note 4.3.1: A second degree equation in x and y will represent a circle if
the coefficients of x2 and y2are equal and the xy term is absent.
Note 4.3.2:
1. If g2 + f2 c is positive, then the equation represents a real circle.
2. If g2 + f2 c is zero, then the equation represents a point.
3. If g2 + f2 c is negative, then the equation represents an imaginary circle.
4.4 LENGTH OF TANGENT FROM POINT P(X1, Y1) TO THE CIRCLE X2 + Y2 + 2GX +
2FY + C = 0
. Let PT be the
Note 4.4.1:
1. If PT2 > 0 then point P(x1, y1) lies outside the circle.
2. If PT2 = 0 then the point P(x1, y1) lies on the circle.
3. If PT2 < 0 then point P(x1, y1) lies inside the circle.
4.5 EQUATION OF TANGENT AT (X1, Y1) TO THE CIRCLE X2 + Y2 + 2GX + 2FY + C = 0
132
The centre of the circle is (g, f). The slope of the radius
A(x1, y1) and B(x2, y2) are the ends of a diameter. Let P(x, y) be any point on
the circumference of the circle. Then
(i.e.) AP PB.
133
The slope of AP is
the slope of BP is
Method 1:
The centre of the circle is (0, 0). The radius of the circle is a. If y = mx + c is
a tangent to the circle, the perpendicular distance from the centre on the
straight line y = mx + c is the radius of the circle.
134
Method 2:
The equation of the circle is
x2 + y2 = a2
(4.2)
y = mx + c
(4.3)
135
Let QR be the chord of contact of tangents from P(x1, y1). Let Q and R be the
points (x2, y2) and (x3,y3), respectively. The equations of tangents
at Q and R are
136
x2 + y2 = a2
(4.6)
This is a quadratic equation in m. Hence, there are two values for m, and
for each value of m there is a tangent. Thus, there are two tangents from a
given point to a circle. Let (x1, y1) be the point of intersection of the two
tangents from (x1, y1). If m1 and m2 are the slopes of the two tangents, then
137
Let QR be a variable chord through the point P(x1, y1). Let the tangents
at Q and R to the circle intersect at T(h, k). Then, QR is the chord of contact
of the tangents from T(h, k). Its equation is
xh + yk + g(x + h) + f(y + k) + c = 0
This chord passes through P(x1, y1). Therefore,
Hence, the polar of (x1, y1) is xx1 + yy1 + g(x + x1) + f(y + y1) + c = 0.
Note 4.10.1.1:
1. If the point (x1, y1) lies outside the circle, the polar of (x1, y1) is the same as the
chord of contact from (x1, y1). If the point lies on the circle, then the tangent at
(x1, y1) is the polar of the pointP(x1, y1).
2. The point (x1, y1) is called the pole of the line xx1 + yy1 + g(x + x1) + f(y + y1)
+ c = 0. Line (4.12)is called the polar of the point (x1, y1).
3. The polar of (x1, y1) with respect to the circle x2 + y2 = a2 is xx1 + yy1 = a2.
138
lx + my + n = 0
(4.13)
xx1 + yy1 = a2
(4.14)
Equations (4.13) and (4.14) represent the same line. Therefore, identifying
these two equations, we get
Definition 4.11.1: Two lines are said to be conjugate with respect to the
circle x2 + y2 = a2 if the pole of either line lies on the other line.
4.11.1 Condition for the Lines lx + my + n = 0 and l1x + m1y + n1 = 0 to be
Conjugate Lines with Respect to the Circle x2 + y2 = a2
139
Let PQ be a chord of the circle x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 and R(x1, y1) be its
middle point.
The equation of any chord through (x1, y1) is
The values of r of this equation are the distances RP and RQ, which are
equal in magnitude but opposite in sign. The condition for this is the
coefficient of r = 0.
140
This is the required equation of the chord PQ in terms of its middle point
(x1, y1). This equation can be expressed in the
form T = S1 where T = xx1 + yy1 + g(x + x1) + f(y + y1)
+ c and
Note 4.12.1: T is the expression we have in the equations of the tangent
(x1, y1) to the circle S: x2 + y2+ 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 and S1 is the expression we
get by substituting x = x1 and y = y1 in the left-hand side of S = 0.
4.13 COMBINED EQUATION OF A PAIR OF TANGENTS FROM (X1, Y1) TO THE
CIRCLE X2 + Y2 + 2GX + 2FY + C = 0
Any point on this line is (x1 + r cos, y1 + r sin). If this point lies on the
circle x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c= 0, then
If chord (4.17) is a tangent to circle (4.18), then the two values of r of this
equation are equal. The condition for this is
141
This equation is the combined equation of the pair of tangents from (x1, y1).
4.14 PARAMETRIC FORM OF A CIRCLE
142
Example 4.1
Find the equation of the circle whose centre is (3, 2) and radius 3 units.
Solution
The equation of the circle is
Example 4.2
Find the equation of the circle whose centre is (a, a) and radius a.
Solution
The centre of the circle is (a, a). The radius of the circle is a. The equation
of the circle is (x a)2 + (y + a)2 = a2 (i.e.) x2 2ax + a2 + y2 +
2ay + a2 = a2 (i.e.) x2 + y2 2ax + 2ay + a2 = 0.
Example 4.3
Find the centre and radius of the following circles:
1.
x2 + y2 14x + 6y + 9 = 0
2. 5x2 + 5y2 + 4x 8y 16 = 0
Solution
1.
143
2.
Example 4.4
Find the equation of the circle whose centre is (2, 2) and which passes
through the centre of the circle x2 + y2 6x 8y 5 = 0
Solution
The centre of the required circle is (2, 2). The centre of the circle x2 + y2
6x 8y 5 = 0 is (3, 4). The radius of the required circle is given by r2 = (2
3)2 + (2 4)2 = 1 + 36 = 37.
144
145
146
(4.30)
147
Subtracting, we get
2f + f = 1 f = 1 g = 2
From (4.31), 4 4 + c = 5 c = 5
Hence, the equation of the circle is x2 + y2 4x 2y 2y 5 = 0.
Example 4.11
Find the equation of the circle cutting off intercepts 4 and 6 on the
coordinate axes and passing through the origin.
Solution
Let the equation of the circle be x2 + y2+ 2gx + 2fy + c = 0. This passes
through the points (0, 0), (4, 0) and (0, 6).
148
4 + 9 16 12 + k = 0 k = 15
149
Example 4.14
The equation of two diameters of a circle are 2x + y 3 = 0 and x 3y + 2 =
0. If the circle passes through the point (2, 5), find its equation.
Solution
The centre of the circle is the point of intersection of the diameter.
Example 4.15
Find the length of the tangent from the point (2, 3) to the circle x2 + y2 +
8x + 4y + 8 = 0.
Solution
The length of the tangent from P(x1, y1) to the circle x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c =
0 is given by
from P(2, 3) to the given circle is
Example 4.16
Determine whether the following points lie outside, on or inside the
circle x2 + y2 4x + 4y 8 = 0:A(0,1), B(5,9), C(2,3).
150
Solution
The equation of the circle is x2 + y2 4x + 4y 8 = 0.
Therefore, point A lies inside the circle. Points B and C lie outside the circle.
Example 4.17
Find the equation of the tangent at the point (2, 5) on the circle x2 + y2
5x + y 14 = 0.
Solution
Given x2 + y2 5x + y 14 = 0
Example 4.18
151
units.
Example 4.19
Show that the circles x2 + y2 2x + 6y + 6 = 0 and x2 + y2 5x + 6y + 15 = 0
touch each other internally.
Solution
For the circle x2 + y2 2x + 6y + 6 = 0,
centre is A(1, 3) and radius
For the circle x2 + y2 5x + 6y + 15 = 0,
centre is
and radius
units
152
Thus, the distance between the centres is equal to the difference in radii.
Hence, the two circles touch each other internally.
Example 4.20
The abscissa of the two points A and B are the roots of the equation x2 +
2x a2 = 0 and the ordinates are the roots of the equation y2 + 4y b2 = 0.
Find the equation of the circle with AB as its diameter. Also find the
coordinates of the centre and the length of the radius of the circle.
Solution
Let the roots of the equation x2 + 2x a2 = 0 be and .
Then
153
Find the equation of a circle that passes through the point (2, 0) and whose
centre is the limit point of the intersection of the lines 3x + 5y = 1 and (2
+ c)x + 5c2 y = 1 as c 1.
Solution
The centre of the circle is the point of intersection of the lines
Example 4.22
154
Find the length intercepted on the y-axis by the chord of the circle joining
the points (4, 3) and (12, 1) as diameter.
Solution
The equation of the circle is
Example 4.23
The rods whose lengths are a and b slide along the coordinate axes in such
a way that their extremities are concyclic. Find the locus of the centre of the
circle.
Solution
Let AB and CB be the portion of x-axis and y-axis, respectively, intercepted
by the circle. Let P(x1, y1) be the centre of the circle.
Draw PL and PM perpendicular to x-axis and y-axis, respectively. Then, by
second property
155
The centres of these two circles are C1(1, 2) and C2(0, 4). The radii of the two
circles are
156
r1 r2 = C1C2. Hence, the circles touch each other internally. The point of
contact C divides C1C2internally in the ratio 1 : 1.
as
Solution
Let A(x1, y1) and B(x2, y2) be the two points on the circumference of the
circle and A(x1, y1) be any point on the circumference.
157
Let
. The slope
of AP and BP are
and
Example 4.26
Show that if the circle x2 + y2 = a2 cuts off a chord of length 2b on the
line y = mx + c, then c2 = (1 +m)2(a2 b2).
Solution
Given x2 + y2 = a2. The centre of the circle is (0, 0). Radius = r = a.
Draw OL perpendicular to AB. Then, L is the midpoint of AB.
158
Example 4.27
A point moves such that the sum of the squares of the distances from the
sides of a square of side unity is equal to a. Show that the locus is a circle
whose centre coincides with the centre of the square.
Solution
Let the centre of the square be the origin. Let P(x, y) be any point. Then, the
equation of the sides are
159
If the
Example 4.29
Show that the locus of a point whose ratio of distances from two given
points is constant is a circle. Hence, show that the circle cannot pass
through the given points.
160
Solution
Let the two points A and B be chosen in the x-axis and the midpoint
of AB be (0, 0). Then let A(a, 0) and B(a, 0). Given
that PA = K PB PA2 = K2PB2 where k is a constant.
x = 9 and y = 8
Thus, B is (9, 8). Hence the equation of the required circle is
161
Example 4.31
One of the diameters of the circle circumscribing the rectangle ABCD is
4y = x + 7. If A and B are the points (3, 4) and (5, 4), respectively, find the
area of the rectangle ABCD.
Solution
Let P (x1, y1) be the centre of the circle and 4y = x + 7 be the equation of the
diameter of BD.
162
163
Moreover, these lines are perpendicular and their slopes are 1 and 1. So,
they make 45 and 135 with the x-axis. Hence one of the bisectors is the xaxis and centre lies on one of the bisectors. If x2 +y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 is
the equation of the circle, then f = 0. Also the perpendicular distance from
(g, 0) to the tangents is equal to the radius.
164
x2 + y2 2x 4y 20 = 0
Centre of this circle is (1, 2)
4x 2y (x + 4) 2(y 2) 20 = 0
(i.e.) 3x 4y 20 = 0
Example 4.35
From the point A(0, 3) on the circle x2 + 4x + (y 3)2 = 0, a chord AB is
drawn and extended to a point M such that AM = AB. Find the equation of
the locus of M.
Solution
165
AM = 2.AB
Hence, B is the midpoint of AM. Then the coordinates of B are
This point B lies on the circle x2 + 4x + (y 3)2 = 0.
166
Example 4.37
Find the area of the triangle formed by the tangents from the point (h, k) to
the circle x2 + y2 = a2 and their chord of contact.
Solution
The equation of the circle is x2 + y2 = a2. Let AB be the chord of contact of
tangents from C (x1, y1). Then the equation of AB is xx1 + yy1 = a2.
167
Example 4.38
Let a circle be given by 2x(x a) + y(2y b) = 0, (a, b 0). Find the
condition on a and b if two chords each intersected by the x-axis can be
drawn to the circle from
168
Solution
The chord is bisected by the x-axis. Let the midpoint of the chord be (h, 0).
The equation of the chord is
Example 4.39
Find the condition that the chord of contact from a point to the
circle x2 + y2 = a2 subtends a right angle at the centre of the circle.
Solution
The equation to the chord of contact from (x1, y1) to the circle
169
Since
, coefficient of x2 + coefficient of y2 = 0.
Example 4.40
If y = mx be the equation of a chord of the circle whose radius is a, the
origin being one of the extremities of the chord and the axis being a
diameter of the circle, prove that the equation of a circle of which this chord
is a diameter is (1 + m2)(x2 + y2) 2a(x + my) = 0.
Solution
Let a be the radius of the circle. Thus (a, 0) is the centre of the circle. The
equation of the circle is
(x a)2 + y2 = a2 x2 + y2 2ax = 0
170
Then,
Example 4.41
Find the equation to the circle that passes through the origin and cuts off
equal chords of length afrom the straight lines y = x and y = x.
Solution
Let the lines y = x and y = x meet the circle at P, P and Q, Q, respectively.
171
are
at
Hence, the equations of the four circles are given by
Example 4.42
Find the locus of the midpoint of chords of the circle x2 + y2 = a2, which
subtends a right angle at the point (c, 0).
Solution
Since AB subtends 90 at C(c, 0), PA = PB = PC. Let P be the point (x1, y1).
Since
, PC = AP.
172
Example 4.43
Find the equations of the circles that touch the coordinate axes and the
line x = a.
Solution
y = 0, x = 0 and x = a are the tangents to the circle. There are two circles as
shown in the figure.
are
Example 4.44
Find the shortest distance from the point (2, 7) to the circle x2 + y2 14x
10y 151 = 0.
Solution
173
Center is (7, 5)
Radius =
The shortest distance of the point P from the circle = CP
r
Example 4.45
Let , and be the parametric angles of three points P, Q and R,
respectively, on the circle x2 + y2 =a2 and A be the point (a, 0). If the length
of the chords AP, AQ and AR are in AP then show that
also in AP.
Solution
Let P(a cos , a sin ), Q(a cos , a sin ), R(a cos r, a sin r)
A is (a, 0)
are
174
Example 4.46
Let S = x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0. Find the locus of the foot of the
perpendicular from the origin on any chord of the circle that subtends a
right angle at the origin.
Solution
Let the equation of the line AB be
lx + my = 1
(4.50)
Let P(x1, y1) be the foot of the perpendicular from the origin on AB. Then,
since OP is perpendicular to AP.
175
lx1+ my1 = 1
(4.52)
Since
Hence,
176
The equation of OP is
Since CP is perpendicular to OP, r is the perpendicular distance
from C on OP.
177
Example 4.48
A circle of circumradius 3k passes through the origin and meets the axes
at A and B. Show that the locus of the centroid of OAB is the
circle x2 + y2 = 4K2.
Solution
Let A and B be the points (a, 0) and (0, b), respectively. Let (x1, y1) be the
centroid of OAB. Then since
, AB is a diameter of the circle.
178
or a =
. The
Example 4.49
A variable line passes through a fixed point (a, b) and cuts the coordinate
axes at the points A and B. Show that the locus of the centre of the
circle AB is
Solution
Since
is
179
Then the perpendicular distance from (h, k) to line (4.56) is equal to the
radius.
180
0.
x2 + y2 22x 4y + 25 = 0
1. 4(x2 + y2) 8(x 2y) + 19 = 0
2. 2x2 + 2y2 + 3x + y + 1 = 0
Ans.: (i) (11, 2), 10
Ans.: (ii) (1, 2),
Ans.:
181
3. Find the equation of the circle passing through the point (2, 4) and having its
centre on the linesx y = 4 and 2x + 3y = 8.
Ans.: x2 + y2 8x 4 = 0
4. Find the equation of the circle whose centre is (2, 3) and which passes
through the point (2, 2).
Ans.: x2 + y2 + 4x 6y 28 = 0
Ans.: 2x 7y 29 = 0
4x + 3y 7 = 0
0.
7. Find the equation of the circle passing through the following points:
Ans.: x2 + y2 x y = 0
9. Find the equation of the circle passing through the points (0, 1) and (4, 3) and
having its centre on the line 4x 5y 5 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 5x 2y + 1 = 0
Ans.: x2 + y2 2x 4y = 164
182
11. Find the equation of the circle circumscribing the triangle formed by the axes
and the straight line 3x + 4y + 12 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + 4x + 3y = 0
12. Show that the points (1, 2), (2, 4), (1, 3) and (2, 0) are on a circle and find
its equation.
13. If the coordinates of the extremities of the diameter of a circle are (3, 5) and
(7, 5), find the equation of the circle.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + 4x 3y = 0
14. Find the equation of the circle when the coordinates of the extremities of one of
its diameters are (4, 1) and (2, 7).
Ans.: x2 + y2 2x + 6y 15 = 0
15. If one end of the diameter of the circle x2 + y2 2x + 6y 15 = 0 is (4, 1), find
the coordinates of the other end.
Ans.: (2, 7)
Ans.: x2 + y2 6x 8y = 0, 3x + 4y = 0
18. Find the slope of the radius of the circle x2 + y2 = 25 through the point (3, 4)
and hence write down the equation of the tangent to the circle at the point.
What are the intercepts made by this tangent on the x-axis and y-axis?
Ans.:
19. One vertex of a square is the origin and two others are (4, 0) and (0, 4). Find
the equation of the circle circumscribing the square. Also find the equation of
the tangent to this circle at the origin.
Ans.: x2 + y2 4x 4 = 0, x + y = 0
183
20. A circle passes through the origin and the points (6, 0) and (0, 8). Find its
equation and also the equation of the tangent to the circle at the origin.
Ans.: x2 + y2 6x 8y = 0, 3x + 4y = 0
21. A and B are two fixed points on a plane and the point P moves on the plane in
such a way thatPA = 2PB always. Prove analytically that the locus of P is a
circle.
22. Does the point (2, 1) lie (i) on, (ii) inside or (iii) outside the circle x2 + y2 4x
6y + 9 = 0?
23. Show that the circles x2 + y2 2x + 2y + 1 = 0 and x2 + y2 + 6x 4y 3 = 0
touch each other externally.
24. Prove that the centres of the three circles x2 + y2 2x + 6y + 1 = 0, x2 + y2 +
4x 12y 9 = 0 and x2 + y2 = 25 lie on the same straight line. What is the
equation of this line?
Ans.: 3x + 4y = 0
25. Prove that the two circles x2 + y2 + 2ax + c2 = 0 and x2 + y2 + 2by + c2 = 0 touch
each other if
26. Show that the circles x2 + y2 4x + 2y + 1 = 0 and x2 + y2 12x + 8y + 43 = 0
touch each other externally.
27. Show that the circles x2 + y2 = 400 and x2 + y2 10x 24y + 120 = 0 touch one
another. Find the co-ordinates of the point of contact.
Ans.:
28. Find the length of the tangent from the origin to the circle 4x2 + 4y2 + 6x + 7y +
1 = 0.
29. Show that the circles x2 + y2 26x 19 = 0 and x2 + y2 + 3x 8y 43 = 0 touch
externally. Find the point of contact and the common tangent.
30. A point moves so that the square of its distance from the base of an isosceles
triangle is equal to the rectangle contained by its distances from the equal
sides. Prove that the locus is a circle.
31. Prove that the centres of the circles x2 + y2 = 1, x2 + y2 + 4x + 8y 1 = 0
and x2 + y2 6x 12y + 1 = 0 are collinear.
32. Prove that the constant in the equation of the circle x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0
is equal to the rectangle under the segments of the chords through the origin.
33. Find the equation of the locus of a point that moves in a plane so that the sum
of the squares from the line 7x 4y 10 = 0 and 4x + 7y + 5 = 0 is always
equal to 3.
184
Ans.:
35. L and M are the feet of the perpendicular from (c, 0) on the lines ax2 +
2hxy + by2 = 0. Show that the equation of LM is (a + b)x + 2hy + bc = 0.
36. A circle has radius 3 units and its centre lies on the line y = x 1. Find the
equation of the circle if it passes through (1, 3).
37. Find the equation of the circle on the line joining the points (4, 3) and (12,
1). Find also the intercepts made by it on the y-axis.
Ans.:
Ans.:
40. Find the equation of the circle passing through the point (3, 5) and (5, 3) and
having its centre on the line 2x + 3y 1 = 0.
41. ABCD is a square whose side is a. Taking line AO as the axis of coordinates,
prove that the equation of the circumcircle of the square is x2 + y2 ax ay =
0.
42. Find the equation of the circle with its centre on the line 2x + y = 0 and
touching the lines 4x 3y + 10 = 0 and 4x 3y 3 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 2x + 4y 11 = 0
43. Find the equation of the circle that passes through the point (1, 1) and touches
the circle x2 + y2+ 4x 6y 3 = 0 at the point (2, 3) on it.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + x 6y + 3 = 0
185
44. Prove that the tangent to the circle x2 + y2 = 5 at the point (1, 2) also touches
the circle x2 + y2 8x + 6y + 20 = 0 and find its point of contact.
Ans.: (3, 1)
45. A variable circle passes through the point A(a, b) and touches the x-axis. Show
that the locus of the other end of the diameter through A is (x c )2 = 4by.
46. Find the equation of the circle passing through the points A(5, 0), B(1, 0),
and C(2, 1) and show that the line 4x 3y 5 = 0 is a tangent to the line.
47. Find the equation of the circle through the origin and through the point of
contact of the tangents from the origin to the circle.
Find k.
Ans.: k = 1
49. A circle of diameter 13 m with centre O coinciding with the origin of coordinate
axes has diameter AB on the x-axis. If the length of the chord AC be 5 m, find
the area of the smaller portion bounded between the circles and the chord AC.
50. Find the radius of the smallest circle that touches the straight line 3x y = 6 at
(1, 3) and also touches the line y = x.
Ans.:
51. If
form distinct points on a circle show
that m1, m2, m3, m4 = 1.
52. If the line x cos + y sin = cuts the circle x2 + y2 = a2 in M and N, then show
that the circle whose diameter is MN is x2 + y2 a2 2(x cos + y sin ) =
0.
53. Show that the tangents drawn from the point (8, 1) to the circle x2 + y2 2x
4y 20 = 0 are perpendicular to each other.
54. How many circles can be drawn each touching all the three lines x + y =
1, y = x + 1 and 7x y = 6? Find the centre and radius of all the circles.
186
Ans.:
55. Find the points on the line x y + 1 = 0, the tangents from which to the
circle x2 + y2 3x = 0 are of length 2 units.
Ans.:
56. On the circle 16x2 + 16y2 + 48x 3y 43 = 0, find the point nearest to the line
8x 4y + 73 = 0 and calculate the distance between this point and the line.
Ans.:
57. Find the equations of the lines touching the circle x2 + y2 + 10x 2y + 6 = 0
and parallel to the line 2x + y 7 = 0.
Ans.: 2x + y 1 = 0, 2x + y + 19 = 0
58. Find the equation of the circle whose diameter is the chord of intersection of
the line x + 3y = 6 and the curve 4x2 + 9y2 = 36.
59. Find the equation for the circle concentric with the circle x2 + y2 8x + 6y 5
= 0 and passes through the point (2, 7).
Ans.: x2 + y2 8x + 6y 27 = 0
60. Find the equation of the circle that cuts off intercepts 1 and 3 on the x-axis
and touches they-axis at the point
Ans.:
61. Find the coordinates of the point of intersection of the line 5x y + 7 = 0 and
the circle x2 + y2 + 3x 4y 9 = 0. Also find the length of the common
segment.
Ans.:
62. The line 4x + 3y + k = 0 is a tangent to the circle x2 + y2 = 4. Find the value of k.
187
Ans.: k = 10
63. Find the equations of tangents to the circle x2 + y2 6x + 4y 17 = 0 that are
perpendicular to 3x 4y + 5 = 0.
Ans.: 4x + 3y + 19 = 0, 4x + 3y 31 = 0
64. Find the equation of tangents to the circle x2 + y2 14x + y 5 = 0 at the points
whose abscissa is 10.
Ans.: 3x + 7y 93 = 0,3x 7y 64 = 0
Ans.: (3, 1)
66. Show that the tangent to the centre x2 + y2 = 0 at the point (1, 2) also touches
the circle x2 + y2 8x + 6y + 20 = 0. Find the point of contact.
Ans.: (3, 1)
Ans.:
69. From the origin, chords are drawn to the circle (x 1)2 + y2 = 1. Find the
equation of the locus of the midpoint of these chords.
Ans.: x2 + y2 x = 0
188
Ans.:
77. Find the equation of the circle that touches the y-axis at a distance of 4 units
from the origin and cuts off an intercept of 6 units from the x-axis.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + 10x 8y + 16 = 0
78. Find the equation of the circle in which the line joining the points (0, b) and
(b, a) is a chord subtending an angle 45 at any point on its circumference
79. From any point on a given circle, tangents are drawn to another circle. Prove
that the locus of the middle point of the chord of contact is a third circle; the
distance between the centres of the given circle is greater than the sum of their
radii.
80.A point moves so that the sum of the squares of the perpendiculars that fall
from it on the sides of an equilateral triangle is constant. Prove that the locus is
a circle.
81. A circle of constant radius passes through the origin O and cuts the axes
in A and B. Show that the locus of the foot of the perpendicular from AB is
(x2 + y2)2(x2 + y2) = 4r2.
82. Find the equation of the image of the circle (x 3)2 + (y 2)2 = 1 by the
mirror x + y = 19.
189
Ans.:
84. A variable circle always touches the line y = x and passes through the point (0,
0). Show that the common chords of this circle and x2 + y2 + 6x + 8y 7 = 0
will pass through a fixed point
85. The equation of the circle that touches the axes of the coordinates and the
line
and whose centre lies in the first quadrant is x2 + y2 2cx
2cy + c2 = 0. Find the values of c.
Ans.: (1, 6)
Ans.: a(1, 3)
87. The points (4, 2) and (3, 6) are conjugate with respect to the circle x2 + y2 =
24. Find the value of b.
Ans.: b = 6
88.If the two circles x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy = 0 and x2 + y2 + 2g1x + 21y = 0 touch
each other, show that 1g = g1.
89. Show that the locus of the points of chords of contact of tangents subtending a
right angle at the centre is a concentric circle whose radius is
times the
radius of the given circle. Also show that this is also the locus of the point of
intersection of perpendicular tangents.
90. Show that the points (xi, yi), i = 1, 2, 3 are collinear if and only if their poles
with respect to the circles x2 + y2 = a2 are concurrent.
91. The length of the tangents from two given points A and B to a circle
are t1 and t2, respectively. If the points are conjugate points, show
that
190
92. Show that the equation to the pair of tangents drawn from the origin to the
circle x2 + y2 + 2gx+ 2y + c = 0 is (gx + y)2 = (2 + g2). Hence find the locus of
the centre of the circle if these tangents are perpendicular.
Ans.: x2 + y2 = 2c
Ans.: 4
98. The tangents to the circle x2 + y2 = 4 at the points A and B meet at P(4, 0).
Find the area of the quadrilateral PAOB.
Ans.:
99. The equations of four circles are (x a)2 + (y a)2 = a2. Find the radius of a
circle touching all the four circles.
Ans.:
100.
A circle of radius 2 touches the coordinate axes in the first quadrant. If
the circle makes a complete rotation on the x-axis along the positive direction
of the x-axis, then show that the equation of the circle in the new position
is x2 + y2 4(x + y) 8x + (2 + 4)2 = 0.
101.
Two tangents are drawn from the origin to a circle with centre at (2, 1).
If the equation of one of the tangents is 3x + y = 0, find the equation of the
other tangent.
Ans.: x 3y = 0
191
102.
Find the equation of the chord of the circle x2 + y2 = a2 passing through
the point (2, 3) farther from the centre.
Ans.: 2x + 3y = 17
103.
An equilateral triangle is inscribed in the circle x2 + y2 = a2, with the
vertex at (a, 0). Find the equation of the side opposite to this vertex.
Ans.: 2x + a = 0
104.
A line is drawn through the point P(3, 1) to cut the circle x2 + y2 = 9
at A and B. Find the value ofPA PB.
Ans.: 121
105.
C1 and C2 are circles of unit radius with their centres at (0, 0) and (1, 0),
respectively. C3 is a circle of unit radius, passing through the centres of the
circles C1 and C2 and having its centre above the x-axis. Find the equation of the
common tangent to C1 and C3 that passes through C2.
Ans.:
106.
subtends an angle
at the point where the circle meets the positive yaxis. Find the equation of the chord.
Ans.: x 2y = 0
107.
A circle with its centre at the origin and radius equal to a meets the axis
of x at A and B. P andQ are respectively the points (a cos, a tan) and
(a cos, a tan) such that = 2. Show that the locus of the point of
intersection of AP and BQ is x2 + y2 2ay tan = 2.
108.
A circle C1 of radius touches the circle x2 + y2 = a2 externally and has its
centre on the positive x-axis. Another circle C2 of radius c touches
circle C1 externally and has its centre on the positivex-axis. If a < b < c, show
that the three circles have a common tangent if a, b, c are in GP.
109.
Find the equations of common tangents to the circles x2 + y2 + 14x
14y + 28 = 0 and x2 + y2 14x + 4y 28 = 0
192
110.
If a circle passes through the points of intersection of the coordinate
axes with the line x y + 1 = 0( 0) and x 2y + 3 = 0 then satisfies the
equation 62 7 + 2 = 0.
111.
OA and OB are equal chords of the circle x2 + y2 2x + 4y = 0
perpendicular to each other and passing through the origin. Show that the
slopes of OA and OB satisfy the equation 3m2 8m 3 = 0.
112.
Find the equation of the circle passing through the points (1, 0) and (0,
1) and having the smallest possible radius.
Ans.: x2 + y2 x y = 0
113.
Find the equation of the circle situated systematically opposite to the
circle x2 + y2 2x = 0 with respect to the line x + y = 2.
Ans.: x2 + y2 4x 2y + 4 = 0
114.
O is a fixed point and R moves along a fixed line L not passing
through O. If S is taken on ORsuch that OR OS = K2, then show that the locus
of S is a circle.
115.
Show that the circumference of the triangle formed by the
lines ax + by + c = 0, bx + cy + a = 0 and cx + ay + b = 0 passes through the
origin if (b2 + c2)(c2 + a2 )(a2 + b2) = abc(b + c)(c + a)(a+ b).
116.
Two circles are drawn through the points (a, 5a) and (4a, a) to touch
the y-axis. Prove that they intersect at an angle
117.
Show that the locus of a point P that moves so that its distance from the
given point O is always in a given ratio n : 1 (n 1) to its distance on the line
joining the points that divides the lineOA in the given ratio as diameter.
118.
The lines 3x 4y + 4 = 0 and 6x 3y 7 = 0 are tangents to the same
circle. Find the radius of the circle.
Ans.:
119.
The line y = x touches a circle at P so that
where O is the
origin. The point (10, 2) is inside the circle and length of the chord on the
line
Ans.: x2 + y2 + 18x 2y + 32 = 0
193
120.
Find the intervals of values of a for which the line y + x = 0 bisects two
to the
circle
121.
Show that all chords of the circle 3x2 y2 2x + 4y = 0 that subtend a
right angle at the origin are concurrent. Does the result hold for the curve 3x2 +
3y2 2x + 4y = 0 ? If yes, what is the point of concurrency, and if not, give the
reason.
122.
Find the equations of the common tangents to the circles x2 + y2 14x +
6y + 33 = 0 and x2 + y2+ 30x 20y + 1 = 0.
Ans.: 4x 3y 12 = 0, 24x + 7y 22 = 0
123.
Prove that the orthocentre of the triangle whose angular points are
(a cos, a sin), (a cos , asin ) and (a cos , a sin ) is the point [a(cos +
cos + cos ), a(sin + sin + sin)].
194
Chapter 5
System of Circles
5.1 RADICAL AXIS OF TWO CIRCLES
Definition 5.1.1: The radical axis of two circles is defined as the locus of a
point such that the lengths of tangents from it to the two circles are equal.
Obtain the equation of the radical axis of the two
circles S x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 and S1 x2 + y2 + 2g1x +
2fy + c1 = 0.
Let P(x1, y1) be a point such that the lengths of tangents to the two circles
are equal.
The locus of (x1, y1) is 2(g g1)x + 2(f f1)y + (c c1) = 0 which is a straight
line.
Therefore, the radical axis of two given circle is a straight line.
Note 5.1.1: If S = 0 and S1 = 0 are the equations of two circles with unit
coefficients for x2 and y2terms then the equation of the radical axis
is S S1 = 0.
195
m1m2 = 1
196
Show that if a circle cuts two given circles orthogonally then its
centre lies on the radical axis of the two given circles.
Let S1 = x2 + y2 + 2g1x + 2f1y + c1 = 0 and S2 = x2 + y2 + 2g2x + 2f2y + c1 = 0 be
the two given circles.
Let S = x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 cuts S1 = 0 and S2 = 0 orthogonally.
197
By subtracting, we get
This shows that (g, f) lies on the line, 2(g1 g2)x + 2(f1 f2)y + (c1 c2) =
0 which is the radical axis of the two circles.
Therefore, the centre of the circle S = 0 lies on the radical axis of the
circles S1 = 0 and S2 = 0.
5.3 COAXAL SYSTEM
198
c c1 = 0 or c = c1.
x2 + y2 + 2x + c = 0
199
This line passes through the other limiting point. For every coaxal system of
circles there exists an orthogonal system of circles. Let x-axis be the line of
centres and y-axis be the common radical axis. Then the equation to a
coaxal system of circles is
cut every circle of the coaxal system of circles given by (5.2) orthogonally.
Then the condition for orthogonality is
Let us now consider two circles of the coaxal system for the different values
of , say 1 and 2. The condition (5.4) becomes 2g1 = c + k, 2g2 = c + k.
2(1 2)g = 0.
200
Since 1 2 0, g = 0 and so k = c.
Hence, from (5.3) the equation of the circle which cuts every member of the
system (5.2) is x2 + y2 + 2fy c = 0, where f is an arbitrary constant.
Therefore, for every coaxal system of circles there exists an orthogonal
system of circles given by x2 + y2 + 2fy c = 0; where f is a variable and c is
a constant. For this system of orthogonal circles y-axis is the line of centres
and x-axis is the common radical axis.
Note 5.4.1: Every circle of the orthogonal coaxal system of circles passes
through the limiting points
.
Theorem 5.4.2: If S = x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0 and S1 = x2 + y2 + 2g1x +
2f1y + c1 = 0 be any two circles of a coaxal system then any circle of coaxal
system can be expressed in the form S + S1 = 0.
Proof:
Consider,
and
201
Consider two members of the system (5.10) for the different values of ,
that is, 1 and 2.
Then, S + 1L = 0 and S + 2L = 0
The radical axis of these two circles is (1 2)L = 0.
Since 1 2 0, L = 0 which is the common radical axis.
Therefore, S + L = 0 represents any circle of the coaxal system in
which S = 0 is a circle and L = 0 is the common radical axis.
5.5 EXAMPLES (RADICAL AXIS)
Example 5.5.1
Find the radical axis of the two circles x2 + y2 + 2x + 4y 7 = 0 and x2 + y2
6x + 2y 5 = 0 and show that it is at right angles to the line of centres of
the two circles.
Solution
202
The radical axis of these two circles is 2(g g1)c + 2(f f1)y + c c1 = 0,
Circle (5.14) bisects the circumference of the circle (515).
Therefore, radical axis passes through the centre of the second circle.
The radical axis of the two given circles be
Example 5.5.3
Show that the circles x2 + y2 4x + 6y + 8 = 0 and x2 + y2 10x 6y + 14 =
0 touch each other and find the coordinates of the point of contact.
Solution
203
Therefore, radical axis touches the first circle and hence the two circles
touch each other.
The equation of the lines of centres is
or
Solving (5.18) and (5.19), we get the point of contact.
Therefore, the point of contact is (3, 1).
Example 5.5.4
Show that the circles x2 + y2 + 2ax + c = 0 and x2 + y2 + 2by + c = 0 touch
if
Solution
The radical axis of the two given circles is 2ax 2by = 0. The centre of the
first circle is (a, 0). The radius of the first circle is
If the two circles touch each other, then the perpendicular distance from
the centre (a, 0) to the radical axis is equal to the radius of the circle.
204
205
Example 5.5.6
Prove that if the points of intersection of the circles x2 + y2 + ax + by + c = 0
and x2 + y2 + a1x + b1y +c1 = 0 by the lines Ax + By + C = 0
and A1x + B1y + C1 = 0 are concyclic if
Solution
Let
206
Example 5.5.7
Prove that the difference of the square of the tangents to two circles from
any point in their plane varies as the distance of the point from their radical
axis.
Solution
Let P(x1, y1) be any point and the two circles be
207
a + b a b = 0.
208
209
Therefore, the two circles cut each other orthogonally. The equation of the
common chord is S S1 = 0.
(i.e.) x2 + y2 8x 6y + 21 + (2x + y 9) = 0.
(i.e.) x2 + y2 4x 4y + 3 = 0
Example 5.5.11
Find the equation to the circle which cuts orthogonally the three
circles x2 + y2 + 2x + 17y + 4 = 0, x2+ y2 + 7x + 6y + 11 = 0 and x2 + y2 x +
22f + 33 = 0.
Solution
Let the equation of the circle which cuts orthogonally the three given circles
be x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2fy + c= 0.
Then the conditions for orthogonality are
210
211
(i.e.) x2 + y2 6x 4y 44 = 0
Example 5.5.12
Find the equation of the circle which passes through the origin, has its
centre on the line x + y = 4 and cuts orthogonally the circle x2 + y2 4x +
2y + 4 = 0.
Solution
Let the equation of the required circle passing through the origin be
Adding, we get
212
Solution
Without loss of generality, we can assume the line of centres of the two
circles as x-axis and the distance between the centres as 2a. Then the
centres of the two circles are (a, 0) and (a, 0). The equation of the two
circles are S = (x a)2 + y2 r2 = 0 and S1 = (x + a)2 + y2 R2 = 0.
Consider
RS rS1 = 0
Clearly, the coefficients of the R and r in these equations are the same and
so they represent circles.
Consider RS + rS1 = 0
R=0
213
are orthogonal.
Exercises (Radical Axis)
Ans.: x 2y + 5 = 0
Ans.: (5, 1)
4. Find the equation of the common chord of the circles x2 + y2 + 2ax + 2by + c =
0 and x2 + y2 + 2bx + 2ay + c = 0 and also show that the circles touch if
(a + b)2 = 2c.
5. Show that the circles x2 + y2 + 2x 8y + 8 = 0 and x2 + y2 + 10x 2y + 22 = 0
touch each other and find the point of contact.
Ans.:
6. Find the equation of the circle passing through the intersection of the
circles x2 + y2 = 6 and x2 +y2 6x + 8 = 0 and also through the point (1, 1).
Ans.: x2 + y2 x y = 0
7. Find the equation of the circle passing through the point of intersection of the
circles x2 + y2 6x + 2y + 4 = 0 and x2 + y2 + 2x 4y 6 = 0 and whose radius
is 3/2.
214
Ans.: (0, 0)
Ans.: (2, 1)
11. The radical centre of three circles is at the origin. The equation of two of the
circles are x2 + y2 = 1 and x2 + y2 + 4x + 4y 1 = 0. Find the general form of the
third circle. If it passes through (1, 1) and (2, 1) then find its equation.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + x 2y 1 = 0
Ans.: (2, 1)
13. Find the equation of the circle whose radius is 3 and which touches the
circle x2 + y2 4x 6y + 2 = 0 internally at the point (1, 1).
14. Show that the radical centres of three circles described on the sides of a triangle
as diameter is the orthocentre of the triangle.
15. Find the equation of the circle which cuts orthogonally the three
circles x2 + y2 + y = 0, x2 + 4y2+ 4x + 7 = 0, 21x2 + y2 + 3x + 5y + 9 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + 4x + 2y + 1 = 0
16. A and B are two fixed points and P moves so that PA = nPB. Show that the
locus of P is a circle and that for different values of n, all the circles have the
same radical axis.
17. Find the equation of circle whose radius is 5 and which touches the
circle x2 + y2 2x 4y 20 = 0 at the point (5, 5).
18. Prove that the length of the common chord of the two circles whose equations
are (x a)2 + (y b)2 = r2 and (x a)2 + (y b)2 = c2 is
19. Find the equation to two equal circles with centres (2, 3) and (5, 6) which cuts
each other orthogonally.
20. If three circles with centres A, B and C cut each other orthogonally in pairs then
prove that the polar of A with respect to the circle centre B passes through C.
215
21. Find the locus of centres of all the circles which touch the line x = 2a and cut
the circle x2 + y2 =a2 orthogonally.
22. A, B are the points (a, 0) and (a, 0). Show that if a variable circle S is
orthogonal to the circle on AB as diameter, the polar of (a, 0) with respect to
the circle S passes through the fixed point (a, 0).
23. If a circle passes through the point (a, b) and cuts the
circle x2 + y2 = k2 orthogonally then prove that the locus of its centres is 2ax +
2by (a2 + b2 + k2) = 0.
24. Show that the circles x2 + y2 + 10x + 6y + 14 = 0 and x2 + y2 4x + 6y + 8 = 0
touch each other at the point (3, 1).
25. Show that the circles x2 + y2 + 2ax + 4ay 3a2 = 0 and x2 + y2 8ax 6ay +
7a2 = 0 touch each other at the point (a, 0).
26. The equation of three circles are x2 + y2 = 1, x2 + y2 + 8x + 15 = 0 and x2 + y2 +
10y + 24 = 0. Determine the coordinate of the point such that the tangents
drawn from it to the three circles are equal in length.
27. If P and Q be a pair of conjugate points with respect to a circle S = 0 then prove
that the circle on PQ as diameter cuts the circle S = 0 orthogonally.
28. Find the equation of the circle whose diameter is the common chord of the
circles x2 + y2 + 2x + 3y + 1 = 0 and x2 + y2 + 4x + 3y + 2 = 0.
5.6 EXAMPLES (LIMITING POINTS)
Example 5.6.1
If A, B and C are the centres of three coaxal circles and t1, t2 and t3 are the
lengths of tangents to them from any point then prove
that
Solution
Let the three circles of coaxal system be
216
Then,
The equation of any circle passing through the intersection of these two
circles is x2 + y2 2x + 1 +(x + 2y 1) = 0.
The
217
Centre is (, 2).
218
Since the radical axis is a diameter, centre lies on the radical axis.
219
Example 5.6.5
Find the equation of the circle which touches x-axis and is coaxal with the
circles x2 + y2 + 12x + 8y 33 = 0 and x2 + y2 = 5.
Solution
220
Example 5.6.6
The line 2x + 3y = 1 cuts the circle x2 + y2 = 4 in A and B. Show that the
equation of the circle on ABas diameter is 13 (x2 + y2) 4x 6y 50 = 0.
Solution
Let
Any circle passing through the intersection of the circle and the line is
Centre is
and radius =
13(x2 + y2) 4x 6y + 50 = 0
Example 5.6.7
A point moves so that the ratio of the length of tangents to the
circles x2 + y2 + 4x + 3 = 0 and x2 + y2 6x + 5 = 0 is 2:3. Show that the locus
of the point is a circle coaxal with the given circles.
Solution
The lengths of tangents from a point P(x1, y1) to the two circles
are
221
Given that,
The locus of
This is of the form S1 + S2 = 0
Hence the locus of circle is a circle coaxal with the two given circles.
Example 5.6.8
Find the limiting points of the coaxal system determined by the
circle x2 + y2 + 2x + 4y + 7 = 0 and x2+ y2 + 4x + 2y + 5 = 0.
Solution
Given that,
222
Solution
Given that
x2 + y2 6x 4y 3 = 0
Since (2, 1) is a limit point, the point circle corresponding to the coaxal
system is
x2 + y2 6x 4y 3 + (2x + 2y + 8) = 0
Centre is (3 , 2 ).
Radius
For point circles, radius = 0.
Therefore, the limiting points are the centres of point circle of the coaxal
system, that is, (2, 1) and (5, 6).
223
Example 5.6.10
Find the equation of the circle which passes though the origin and belongs
to the coaxal system of which limiting points are (1, 2) and (4, 3).
Solution
Since (1, 2) and (4, 3) are limiting points of two circles of the coaxal system
and (x 1)2 + (y 2)2 = 0 and (x 4)2 + (y 3)2 = 0.
Radical axis is 6x + 2y 20 = 0.
Any circle of the system is x2 + y2 2x 4y + 5 + (6x + 2y 20) = 0.
This passes through the origin.
Example 5.6.11
A point P moves so that its distances from two fixed points are in a constant
ratio . Prove that the locus of P is a circle. If varies then show
that P generates a system of coaxal circles of which the fixed points are the
limiting points.
Solution
Let P(x1, y1) be a moving point and A(c, 0) and B(0, c) be the two fixed
points. Here, we have chosen the fixed points on the x-axis such that P is its
midpoint. Given that
224
225
Exercises
1. Find the equation of the circle passing through the intersection of x2 + y2 6 =
0 and x2 + y2 + 4y 1 = 0 through the point (1, 1).
2. Show that the circles x2 + y2 = 480 and x2 + y2 10x 24y + 120 = 0 touch each
other and find the equation, if a third circle which touches the circles at their
point of intersection and the x-axis x2 + y2 200x 400y + 10000 = 0.
3. Find the equation of the circle whose centre lies on the line x + y 11 = 0 and
which passes through the intersection of the circle x2 + y2 3x + 2y 4 = 0
with the line 2x + 5y 2 = 0.
4. Find the length of the common chord of the circles x2 + y2 + 4x 22y = 0
and x2 + y2 10x + 5y= 0.
Ans.: 40/7
5. Find the coordinates of the limiting points of the coaxal circles determined by
the two circles x2+ y2 4x 6y 3 = 0 and x2 + y2 24x 26y + 277 = 0.
226
6. Find the coordinates of the limiting points of the coaxal system of circles of
which two members are x2 + y2 + 2x 6y = 0 and 2x2 + 2y2 10y + 5 = 0.
8. Find the limiting point of the coaxal system determined by the circles x2 + y2
6x 6y + 4 = 0 and x2 + y2 2x 4y + 3 = 0.
Ans.:
9. Find the equation of the coaxal system of circles one of whose members
is x2 + y2 4x 2y 5 = 0 and the limiting point is (1, 2).
Ans.: x2 + y2 2x 4y + 5 + (x y 5) = 0
227
Chapter 6
Parabola
6.1 INTRODUCTION
If a point moves in a plane such that its distance from a fixed point bears a
constant ratio to its perpendicular distance from a fixed straight line then
the path described by the moving point is called a conic. In other words,
if S is a fixed point, l is a fixed straight line and P is a moving point
and PM is the perpendicular distance from P on l, such
that
constant, then the locus of P is called a conic. This constant is
called the eccentricity of the conic and is denoted by e.
228
(i.e.)
This equation can be expressed in the form ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx +
2fy + c = 0 which is a second degree equation in x and y.
6.3 EQUATION OF A PARABOLA
Let S be the focus and the line l be the directrix. We have to find the locus of
a point P such that its distance from the focus S is equal to its distance from
the fixed line l.
(i.e.)
Draw SX perpendicular to the directrix and bisect SX. Let A be the point of
bisection and SA = AX =a. Then the point A is a point on the parabola
since
. Take AS as the x-axis and AYperpendicular to AS as the y-axis.
Then the coordinate of S are (a, 0). Let (x, y) be the coordinates of the
point P. Draw PN perpendicular to the x-axis.
This, being the locus of the point P, is the equation of the parabola. This
equation is the simplest possible equation to a parabola and is called the
standard equation of the parabola.
229
Note 6.3.1:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
1. If the focus is taken at the point (a, 0) with the vertex at the origin and its axis
as x-axis then its equation is y2 = 4ax.
230
2. If the axis of the parabola is the y-axis, vertex at the origin and the focus at
(0, a), the equation of the parabola is x2 = 4ay.
3. If the focus is at (0, a), vertex (0, 0) and axis as y-axis, then the equation of
the parabola is x2= 4ay.
Example 6.1
Find the equation of the parabola with the following foci and directrices:
231
1.
(1, 2): x + y 2 = 0
2. (1, 1): x y = 0
3. (0, 0): x 2y + 2 = 0
Solution
1.
232
Example 6.2
Find the foci, latus rectum, vertices and directrices of the following
parabolas:
1.
y2 + 4x 2y + 3 = 0
2. y2 4x + 2y 3 = 0
3. y2 8x 9 = 0
Solution
1.
the
or 2x 1 = 0.
233
and take
Exercises
1. Find the equation of the parabola whose focus is (2, 1) and directrix is 2x + y +
1 = 0.
234
3. Find the coordinates of the vertex, focus and the equation of the directrix of the
parabola 3y2 = 16x. Find also the length of the latus rectum.
Ans.:
4. Find the coordinates of the vertex and focus of the parabola 2y2 + 3y + 4x = 2.
Find also the length of the latus rectum.
Ans.:
5. A point moves in such a way that the distance from the point (2, 3) is equal to
the distance from the line 4x + 3y = 5. Find the equation of its path. What is
the name of this curve?
Solving equations (6.1) and (6.2), we get their points of intersection. The xcoordinates of the points of intersection are given by
235
Show that two tangents can always be drawn from a point to a parabola.
Solution
Let the equation to the parabola be y2 = 4ax. Let (x1, y1) be the given point.
Any tangent to the parabola is
(x1, y1), then
equation in m.
Therefore, there are two values of m and for each value of m there is a
tangent. Hence, there are two tangents from a given point to the parabola.
Note 6.7.1: If m1, m2 are the slopes of the two tangents then they are the
roots of equation (6.3).
236
If m1, m2 are the slopes of the two tangents from (x1, y1), then they are the
roots of equation (6.5). Since the tangents are perpendicular,
If the tangents make complementary angles with the axis of the parabola,
then m1 = tan and m2 = tan(90 ).
237
Find the equation of the tangent at (x1, y1) to the parabola y2 = 4ax.
Let P(x1, y1) and Q(x2, y2) be two points on the parabola y2 = 4ax. Then
The equation of the chord joining the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) is
When the point Q(x2, y2) tends to coincide with P(x1, y1), the
chord PQ becomes the tangent at P.
Hence, the equation of the tangent at P is
238
Find the equation of the normal at (x1, y1) on the parabola y2 = 4ax.
Solution
The slope of the tangent at (x1, y1) is
Therefore, the slope of the normal at (x1, y1) is
The equation of the normal at (x1, y1) is
Find the equation of the chord of contact of tangents from (x1, y1) to the
parabola y2 = 4ax.
239
Solution
Let QR be the chord of contact of tangents from P(x1, y1). Let Q and R be the
points (x2, y2) and (x3,y3), respectively. Then, the equation of tangents
at Q and R are
These two equations show that the points (x2, y2) and (x3, y3) lie on the
line yy1 = 2a(x + x1).
Therefore, the equation of the chord of contact of tangents from P(x1, y1)
is yy1 = 2a(x + x1).
6.12 POLAR OF A POINT
Find the polar of the point with respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax.
Definition 6.12.1 The polar of a point with respect to a parabola is
defined as the locus of the point of intersection of the tangents at the
extremities of a chord passing through that point.
Solution
Let P(x1, y1) be the given point. Let QR be a variable chord passing
through P. Let the tangents at Qand R intersect at (h, k). Then the equation
240
of the chord of contact of tangents from (h, k) is yk = 2a(x + h). This chord
passes through P(x1, y1).
y1k = 2a (x1 + h)
Note 6.12.1: Point P is the pole of the line yy1 = 2a(x + x1).
Note 6.12.2: Find the pole of the line lx + my + n = 0 with respect to the
parabola y2 = 4ax.
Let (x1, y1) be the pole. Then the polar of (x1, y1) is
(6.13)
Equations (6.12) and (6.13) represent the same line. Then, identifying these
two equations, we get
241
Definition 6.13.1 Two lines are said to be conjugate to each other if the
pole of each lies on the other.
Find the condition for the lines lx + my + n = 0 and l1x + m1y + n1 = 0 to be
conjugate lines with respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax.
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the pole of the lines l1x + m1y + n1 = 0 with respect to the
parabola. The polar of (x1, y1) with respect to the polar y2 =
4ax is lx + my + n = 0.
The equation of the polar of (x1, y1) with respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax is
(6.15)
Equations (6.14) and (6.15) represent the same line. Identifying these two
equations, we get
Find the equation of pair of tangents from (x1, y1) to the parabola y2 = 4ax.
Solution
242
The two values of r of this equation are the distances of point (x, y) to the
point (x1, y1). If line (6.16)is a tangent to the parabola, then the two values
of r must be equal and the condition for this is the discriminant of
quadratic (6.17) is zero.
243
Find the equation of a chord of the parabola in terms of its middle point
(x1, y1).
Solution
Let the equation of the chord be
Any point on this line is (x1 + rcos, y1 + rsin). When the chord meets the
parabola y2 = 4ax, this point lies on the curve.
The two values of r are the distances RP and RQ, which are equal in
magnitude but opposite in sign. The condition for this is the coefficient
of r is equal to zero.
244
x = at2, y = 2at satisfy the equation y2 = 4ax. This means (at2, 2at) is a point
on the parabola. This point is denoted by t and t is called a parameter.
6.17 CHORD JOINING TWO POINTS
Solution
The equation of the chord joining the points is
Find the equation of the tangent and normal at t on the parabola y2 = 4ax.
Solution
The equation of the parabola is y2 = 4ax. Differentiating with respect to x,
245
246
Show that three normals can always be drawn from a given point to a
parabola.
Solution
Let the equation of the parabola be y2 = 4ax.
The equation of the normal at t is
y + xt = 2at + at3
This being a cubic equation in t, there are three values for t. For each value
of t there is a normal from (x1, y1) to the parabola y2 = 4ax.
Note 6.21.1: If t1, t2, t3 are the roots of equation (6.18), then
247
Prove that a circle and a parabola meet at four points and show that the
sum of the ordinates of the four points of intersection is zero.
Solution
Let the equation of the circle be
Any point on the parabola is (at2, 2at). When the circle and the parabola
intersect, this point lies on the circle,
This being a fourth degree equation in t, there are four values of t. For each
value of t there is a point of intersection. Hence, there are four points of
intersection of a circle and a parabola. If t1, t2, t3, t4 be the four roots
of equation (6.24), then
248
Therefore, the sum of the ordinates of the four points of intersection is zero.
ILLUSTRATIVE EXAMPLES BASED ON TANGENTS AND NORMALS
Example 6.3
Find the equations of the tangent and normal to the parabola y2 = 4(x 1)
at (5, 4).
Solution
y2 = 4(x 1)
249
Example 6.5
A common tangent is drawn to the circle x2 + y2 = r2 and the parabola y2 =
4ax. Show that the angle which it makes with the axis of the parabola is
given by
Solution
Let y = mx + c be a common tangent to the parabola
Equations (6.29) and (6.30) represent the same straight line. Identifying we
get
250
Example 6.6
A straight line touches the circle x2 + y2 = 2a2 and the parabola y2 = 8ax.
Show that its equation is y= (x + 2a).
Solution
The equation of the circle is
Equations (6.33) and (6.34) represent the same straight line. Identifying we
get,
251
m2 = 1 or 2; m2 = 2 is impossible.
m2 = 1 or m = 1
y = (x + 2a)
Example 6.7
Show that for all values of m, the line y = m(x + a) + will touch the
parabola y2 = 4a(x + a). Hence show that the locus of a point, the two
tangents form which to the parabolas y2 = 4a(x + a) and y2 = 4b(x + b) one
to each are at right angles, is the line x + a + b = 0.
Solution
Solving (6.35) and (6.36), we get their points of intersection. The xcoordinates of their points of intersection are given by,
252
The two values of x and hence of y of the points of intersection are the
same. Hence,
is a tangent to the parabola y2 = 4a(x + a). Let
(x1, y1) be the point of intersection of the two tangents to the parabola y2 =
4a(x + a), y2 = 4a(y + b). The tangents are
Since they pass through (x1, y1), we have
and
since
Cancelling
The locus of (x1, y1) is x + a + b = 0.
Example 6.8
Prove that the locus of the point of intersection of two tangents to the
parabola y2 = 4ax, which makes an angle of with x-axis, is y2 4ax =
(x + a)2 tan2. Determine the locus of point of intersection of perpendicular
tangents.
253
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the point of intersection of tangents. Any tangent to the
parabola is y = mx + . If this passes through (x1, y1) then y = mx1 + .
254
If m1 and m2 are the slopes of the two tangents to the parabola then m1m2 =
1. (i.e.) tan tan(90 ) = 1.
(i.e.) The tangent makes complementary angles to the axis of the parabola.
Example 6.10
Prove that the locus of poles of the chords of the parabola y2 = 4ax which
subtends a constant angle at the vertex is the curve (x + 4a)2 tan2 = 4(y2
4ax).
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the pole of a chord of the parabola. Then the polar of (x1, y1) is
which is the chord of contact from (x1, y1). The combined equation of the
lines AQ and AR is got by homogenization of the equation of the
parabola y2 = 4ax with the help of (6.40).
The combined equation of the lines is
255
x + a = 0 or x = a.
The chord of contact passes through the point (a, 0) where the axis cuts
the directrix.
Example 6.12
Find the locus of poles of tangents to the parabola y2 = 4ax with respect to
the parabola x2 = 4by.
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the pole with respect to the parabola x2 = 4by. Then the polar
of (x1, y1) is xx1 = 2b(y +y1),
(i.e.)
or x1y1 + 2ab = 0.
256
k = 2ay1.
The equation of the perpendicular to the polar from (0, y1) is y1x + 2ay =
2ay1, when this line meets the x-axis, y1x = 2ay1 or x = 2a
Hence, the perpendicular passes through the point (2a, 0), a fixed point on
the axis of the parabola.
Example 6.14
The polar of any point with respect to the circle x2 + y2 = a2 touches the
parabola y2 = 4ax. Show that the point lies on the parabola y2 = ax.
Solution
The polar of the point (x1, y1) with respect to the
circle x2 + y2 = a2 is xx1 + yy1 = a2
257
(i.e.)
. This is a tangent to the circle x2 + y2 = a2. The condition
for this is c2 = a2 (1 + m2).
258
Let P be the point (x1, y1). The polar of P with respect to y2 = 4ax is
259
P is the variable point on the tangent at the vertex of the parabola y2 = 4ax.
The equation of the tangent at the vertex is x = 0. Any point on the tangent
at the vertex is P (0, y1). The polar of (0, y) is
2ay1 = k.
Let (l, m) be the point of intersection of (6.42) and (6.43). Then 2al my1 =
0.
Solving
Now,
260
261
The midpoint
Similarly,
262
Also
Let LSL be the latus rectum of the parabola y2 = 4ax. The coordinates
of L are (a, 2a). The equation of tangent at L is y 2a = 2a(x + a)
263
Latus rectum bisects the angle between the tangents and normal at L.
Example 6.22
Show that the locus of the points of intersection of tangents to y2 =
4ax which intercept a constant length d on the directrix is (y2 4ax)
(x + a)2 = d2x2.
Solution
Let P(x1, y1) be the point of intersection tangent to the parabola. Then the
equation of the pair of tangents PQ and PR is T2 = SS1.
(i.e.) [yy1 2a(x + x1]2 = (y2 4ax)(y2 4ax1). When these lines meet the
directrix x = a, we have
If y1 and y2 are the ordinates of the point of intersection of tangents with the
directrix x + a = 0, then
264
Then
Let (x1, y1) be the midpoint of the chord PQ. Then the equation
of PQ is T = S1
265
The locus of (x1, y1) is y2 = 2a(x 4a) which is a parabola whose latus
rectum is half the latus rectum of the given parabola.
Example 6.24
Show that the locus of midpoints of chords of the parabola of constant
length 2l is (y2 4ax) (y2 + 4a2) + 4a2l2 = 0.
Solution
Any point on this line is (x1 + r cos, y1 + r sin). This point lies on the
parabola y2 = 4ax.
266
The two values of r are the distances RP and RQ which are equal in
magnitude but opposite in sign. The condition for this is the coefficient
of r = 0. (i.e.) y1sin 2a cos = 0.
Let (x1, y1) be the midpoint of a chord of this parabola. Then its equation
is
If this is a focal chord then this passes through (a, 0).
267
is
268
The equation of the chord of contact from (a, 0) to the parabola y2 = 4ax is
0 = 2a(x a) or x a = 0.
When x = a, y = 2a. Hence N and Q are (a, 2a) and (a, 2a).
When
Example 6.27
The polar of a point P with respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax meets the curve
in Q and R. Show that ifP lies on the line lx + my + n = 0 then the locus of
the middle point of the QR is l(y2 4ax) + 2a(lx +my + n) = 0.
Solution
Let P be the point (h, k). The polar of P(h, k) with respect to the
parabola y2 = 4ax is
The polar of P meets the parabola y2 = 4ax at Q and R. Let P(x1, y1) be the
midpoint of QR. Its equation is
269
Example 6.28
Prove that area of the triangle inscribed in the parabola y2 =
4ax is
vertices of the triangle.
Solution
Let (x1, y1), (x2, y2) and (x3, y3) be the vertices of the triangle inscribed in the
parabola y2 = 4ax. Then the vertices are
of the triangle is
. The area
Example 6.29
An equilateral triangle is inscribed in the parabola y2 = 4ax one of whose
vertices is at the vertex of the parabola. Find its side.
Solution
270
Exercises
1. Show that two tangents can be drawn from a given point to a parabola. If the
tangents make angles 1 and 2 with x axis such that
3. Show that the locus of the poles of chords of the parabola y2 = 4ax which
subtends an angle of 45 at the vertex is the curve (x + a)2 = 4(y2 4ax).
4. Show that the locus of poles of all tangents to the parabola y2 = 4ax with
respect to the parabolay2 = 4bx is the parabola ay2 = 4b2x.
5. Show that the locus of poles of chords of the parabola which subtends a right
angle at the vertex is x + 4a = 0.
271
6. Show that if tangents be drawn to the parabola y2 = 4ax from any point on the
straight line x + 4a = 0, the chord of contact subtends a right angle at the
vertex of the parabola.
7. Perpendiculars are drawn from points on the tangent at the vertex on their
polars with respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax. Show that the locus of the foot of
the perpendicular is a circle centre at (a, 0) and radius a.
8. Show that the locus of poles with respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax of tangents to
the circle x2 +y2 = 4a2 is x2 y2 = 4a2.
9. A point P moves such that the line through the perpendicular to its polar with
respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax touches the parabola x2 = 4by. Show that the
locus of P is 2ax + by + 4a2x = 0.
10. If a chord of the parabola y2 = 4ax subtends a right angle at its focus, show that
the locus of the pole of this chord with respect to the given parabola is x2 + y2 +
6ax + a2 = 0.
11. Show that the locus of poles of all chords of the parabola y2 = 4ax which are at
a constant distance d from the vertex is d2y2 + 4a2 (d2 x2) = 0.
12. Show that the locus of poles of the focal chords of the parabola y2 =
4ax is x + a = 0.
13. If two tangents to the parabola y2 = 4ax make equal angles with a fixed line
show that the chord of contact passes through a fixed point.
14. Prove that the polar of any point on the circle x2 + y2 2ax 3a2 = 0 with
respect to the circle x2+ y2 + 2ax 3a2 = 0 touches the parabola y2 = 4ax.
15. Show that the locus of the poles with respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax of the
tangents to the curve x2 y2 = a is the ellipse 4x2 + y2 = 4ax.
16. P is a variable point on the line y = b, prove that the polar of P with respect to
the parabola y2 = 4ax is a fixed directrix.
17. The perpendicular from a point O on its polar with respect to a parabola meet
the polar in the points M and cuts the axis in G. The polar meets x-axis in T and
the ordinate through Ointersects the curve in P and P. Show that the points G,
M, P, P and T lie on a circle whose centre is at the focus S.
18. Tangents are drawn to the parabola y2 = 4ax from a point (h, k). Show that the
area of the triangle formed by the tangents and the chord of contact
is
19. Prove that the length of the chord of contact of the tangents drawn from the
point (x1, y1) to the parabola y2 = 4ax is
Hence show that
one of the triangles formed by these tangents and their chord of contact
is
272
20. Tangents are drawn from a variable point P to the parabola y2 = 4ax such that
they form a triangle of constant area with the tangent at the vertex. Show that
the locus of P is (y2 4ax)x2= 4c2.
21. Prove that the tangent to a parabola and the perpendicular to it from its focus
meet on the tangent at the vertex.
22. Show that a portion of a tangent to a parabola intercepted between directrix
and the curve subtends a right angle at the focus.
23. The tangent to the parabola y2 = 4ax make angles 1 and 2 with the axis. Show
that the locus of the point of intersection such that cot1 + cot2 = c is y = ac.
24. If perpendiculars be drawn from any two fixed points on the axis of a parabola
equidistant from the focus on any tangent to it, show that the difference of
their squares is a constant.
25. Prove that the equation of the parabola whose vertex and focus on x-axis at
distances 4a and 5afrom the origin respectively (a > 0) is y2 = 4a(x 4a). Also
obtain the equation to the tangent to this curve at the end of latus rectum in the
first quadrant.
Ans.:y = x a
26. Chords of a parabola are drawn through a fixed point. Show that the locus of
the middle points is another parabola.
27. Find the locus of the middle points of chords of the parabola y2 = 2x which
touches the circle x2+ y2 2x 4 = 0.
28. A tangent to the parabola y2 + 4bx = 0 meets the parabola y2 = 4ax at P and Q.
Show that the locus of the middle point of PQ is y2(2a + b) = 4a2x.
29. Through each point of the straight line x my = h is drawn a chord of the
parabola y2 = 4axwhich is bisected at the point. Prove that it always touches the
parabola (y + 2am)2 = 8axh.
30. Two lines are drawn at right angles, one being a tangent to the parabola y2 =
4ax and the other to y2 = 4by. Show that the locus of their point of intersection
is the curve (ax + by) (x2 + y2) = (bx ay)2.
31. A circle cuts the parabola y2 = 4ax at right angles and passes through the focus.
Show that the centre of the circle lies on the curve y2(a + x) = a(a + bx)2.
32. Two tangents drawn from a point to the parabola make angles 1 and 2 with
the x-axis. Show that the locus of their point of intersection if tan21 +
tan22 = c is y2 cx2 = 2ax.
33. If a triangle PQR is inscribed in a parabola so that the focus S is the orthocentre
and the sides meet the axes in points K, L and M then prove that SK SL SM
4SA2 = 0 where A is the vertex of the parabola.
273
34. Chords of the parabola y2 = 4ax are drawn through a fixed point (h, k). Show
that the locus of the midpoint is a parabola whose vertex is
and latus
rectum is 2a.
35. Show that the locus of the middle points of a system of parallel chords of a
parabola is a line which is parallel to the axis of the parabola.
36. Show that the locus of the midpoints of chords of the parabola which subtends
a constant angle at the vertex is (y2 2ax 8a2)2 tan2 = 162(4ax y2).
ILLUSTRATIVE EXAMPLES BASED ON PARAMETERS
Example 6.30
Prove that perpendicular tangents to the parabola will intersect on the
directrix.
Solution
Let the tangents at t1 and t2 intersect at P. The equation of tangents
at t1 and t2 are
The slopes of the tangents are
perpendicular,
t1t2 = 1
The point of intersection of the tangents at t1 and t2 is P(at1t2, a(t1 + t2)) (i.e.)
(a, a(t1 + t2)). This point lies on the line x + a = 0.
Perpendicular tangents intersect on the directrix.
Example 6.31
Prove that the tangents at the extremities of a focal chord intersect at right
angles on the directrix.
274
Solution
Let t1 and t2 be the extremities of a focal chord. Then the equation of the
chord is y (t1 + t2) = 2x + 2at1t2.
This passes through the focus (a, 0).
y = at
275
Hence, the point of intersection of (6.59) and (6.60) is (0, at) and this point
lies on y-axis.
Example 6.33
Show that the orthocentre of the triangle formed by the tangents at three
points on a parabola lies on the directrix.
Solution
Let t1, t2 and t3 be points of contact of the tangents at the points A, B and C,
respectively on the parabola y2 = 4ax, forming a triangle PQR. The equation
of QR is
276
The coordinates of the ends of a focal chord of the parabola y2 = 4ax are
(x1, y1) and (x2, y2). Prove that x1x2 = a2 and y1y2 = 4a2.
Solution
Let t1 and t2 be the ends of a focal chord. Then the equation of the focal
chord is y(t1 + t2) = 2x + at1t2. Since this passes through the focus (a, 0), 0 =
2a + at1t2 or t1t2 = 1.
Example 6.35
A quadrilateral is inscribed in a parabola and three of its sides pass through
fixed points on the axis. Show that the fourth side also passes through a
fixed point on the axis of the parabola.
Solution
Let t1, t2, t3 and t4 be respectively vertices A, B, C and D of the quadrilateral
inscribed in the parabolay2 = 4ax. The equation of chord AB is
When this meets the x-axis y = 0 (i.e.) x = at1t2 = k1. Since AB meets the xaxis at a fixed point,
Similarly,
Multiplying these, we get
277
Hence, the fourth side of the quadrilateral also passes through a fixed point.
Example 6.36
Tangents to the parabola y2 = 4ax are drawn at points whose abscissae are
in the ratio k:1. Prove that the locus of their point of intersection is the
curve y2 = (k1/4 + k1/4)2x2.
Solution
Let the tangents at t1 and t2 intersect at P(x1, y1)
Given that
278
Let (a, y1) be a point on the directrix. Let t be the point of contact of
tangents from (a, y1) to the parabola y2 = 4ax. The equation of the tangent
at t is
279
Let P(x1, y1) be the point of intersection of tangents at t1 and t2. The equation
of the tangent at t1 is
This meets the tangent at the vertex at Q.
Q is (0, at1). Similarly, R is (0, at2). P is the point of intersection of
tangents at t1 and t2 and the point is P(at1t2, a(t1 + t2)). The area of PQR is
given as c2.
280
Example 6.40
Prove that the locus of the point of intersection of normals at the ends of a
focal chord of a parabola is another parabola whose latus rectum is one
fourth of that of the given parabola.
Solution
Let the equation of the parabola be
281
The locus of (x1, y1) is y2 = a(x 3a) which is a parabola whose latus rectum
is one fourth of the latus rectum of the original parabola.
Example 6.41
If the normal at the point t1 on the parabola y2 = 4ax meets the curve again
at t2 prove that
Solution
The equation of the normal at t1 is
282
Example 6.42
If the normals at two points t1, t2 on the parabola y2 = 4ax intersect again at
a point on the curve show that t1 + t2 + t3 = 0 and t1t2 = 2 and the product of
ordinates of the two points is 8a2.
Solution
The normals t1 and t2 meet at t3.
Subtracting
Since t1 t2 0, t1t2 = 2.
Example 6.43
Find the condition that the line lx + my + n = 0 is a normal to the parabola
is y2 = 4ax.
Solution
Let the line lx + my + n = 0 be a normal at t. The parabola is y2 = 4ax. The
equation of the normal att is
283
and
Example 6.44
Show that the locus of poles of normal chords of the parabola is y2 = 4ax is
(x + 2a) y2 + 4a3 = 0.
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the pole of a normal chord normal at t. The equation of the
polar of (x1, y1) is
284
Example 6.45
In the parabola y2 = 4ax the tangent at the point P whose abscissa is equal
to the latus rectum meets the axis on T and the normal at P cuts the curve
again in Q. Prove that PT:TQ = 4:5.
Solution
Let P and Q be the points t1 and t2 respectively. Given
that
Hence T is the point (4a, 0). Also as the normal at t1 meets the curve at t2,
Example 6.46
Show that the locus of a point such that two of the three normal drawn from
it to the parabola y2 = 4ax coincide is 27ay2 = 4(x 2a)3.
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be a given point and t be foot of the normal from (x1, y1) to the
parabola y2 = 4ax. The equation of the normal at t is
285
If t1, t2 and t3 be feet of the normals from (x1, y1) to the parabola
then t1, t2 and t3 are the roots ofequation (6.84).
Since t1 is a root
of equation (6.84)
Example 6.47
If the normals from a point to the parabola y2 = 4ax cut the axis in points
whose distances from the vertex are in AP then show that the point lies on
the curve 27ay2 = 2(x 2a)3.
286
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be a given point and t be the foot of a normal from (x1, y1). The
equation of the normal at tis
If t1, t2 and t3 be the feet of the normals from (x1, y1) then
287
If t1, t2 and t3 be the feet of the three normals from (x1, y1)
then
Example 6.49
Prove that a normal chord of a parabola which subtends a right angle at the
vertex makes an angle
288
Solution
Let the equation of the parabola be
289
Prove that the area of the triangle formed by the normals to the
parabola y2 = 4ax at the points t1, t2and t3 is
Solution
The equations of the normals at t1, t2, t3 are
Solving these equations pair wise we get the vertices of the triangle. Hence
the vertices are
and two other similar points.
Example 6.51
Prove that the length of the intercepts on the normal at the point P(at2, 2at)
to the parabola y2 = 4axmade by the circle described on the line joining the
focus and P as diameter is
Solution
The equation of the normal at P is y + xt = 2at + at3.
290
Let the circle on PS as diameter cut the normal at P at R and the x-axis at T.
Example 6.52
Normals at three points P, Q and R of the parabola y2 = 4ax meet in (h, k).
Prove that the centroid of PQR lies on the axis at a distance
the vertex.
from
Solution
Let t be a foot of a normal from (h, k). The equation of the normal at t is
at3 + t (2a h) k = 0.
If t1, t2 and t3 are the feet of the normals from (h, k) then t1 + t2 + t3 =
0,
291
Centroid is at a distance
Example 6.53
The normals at three points P, Q and R on a parabola meet at T and S be
the focus of the parabola. Prove that SPSQSR = aTS2.
Solution
Let T be the point (h, k). Then P, Q and R are the feet of the normals
from T(h, k). The equation of the normal at t is y + xt = 2at + at3.
If t1, t2 and t3 be the feet of the normals from T then t1 + t2 + t3 = 0.
292
Example 6.54
The equation of a chord PQ of the parabola y2 = 4ax is lx + my = 1. Show
that the normals at P, Qmeet on the normal at
Solution
Let P and Q be the points t1 and t2. The normals at P and Q meet at R. If t3 is
the foot of the normal of the 3rd point then
293
Example 6.55
If the normal at P to the parabola y2 = 4ax meets the curve at Q and make
an angle with the axis show that
1.
and
Solution
Let P be the point (at2, 2at). The equation of the normal at t is y + xt =
2at + at3. The normal at tmeets the curve at
Let be the angle between the normal and the tangent at Q. The slope of
the tangent at Q is
Slope of the normal at t is t.
since tan = t
294
Example 6.56
Prove that the circle passing through the feet of the three normals to a
parabola drawn from any point in the plane passes through the vertex of
the parabola. Also find the equation of the circle passing through the feet of
the normals.
Solution
Let the equation of the parabola be
Let P, Q and R be the feet of the normals to y2 = 4ax from a given point
(h, k). Then we have at3 + (2a h)t k = 0.
If t1, t2 and t3 be the feet of the normals at P, Q and R then t1 + t2 + t3 = 0. We
know that the circle(6.111) and the parabola (6.110) cut at four points and
if t1, t2, t3 and t4 are the four points of intersection of the circle and the
parabola then they are the roots of the equation,
If t1, t2 and t3 correspond to the feet of the normals from (h, k) then
295
since c = 0
Equations (6.111) and (6.115) are the same. By comparing the coefficients,
we get
The equation of the circle passing through the feet of the normal
is
Exercises
1. Show that the portion of the tangent intercepted between the point of contact
and the directrix subtends a right angle at the focus.
2. If the tangent at a point P on the parabola meets the axis at T and PN is the
ordinate at P then show that AN = AT.
3. If the tangent at P meets the tangent at the vertex in Y then show that SY is
perpendicular to TPand SY2 = AS SP.
4. If A, B and C, are three points on a parabola whose ordinates are in GP then
prove that the tangents at A and C meet on the ordinates of B.
5. Prove that the middle point of the intercepts made on a tangent to a parabola
by the tangents at two points P and Q lies on the tangent which is parallel
to PQ.
6. If points (at2, 2at) is one extremity of a focal chord of the parabola y2 = 4ax,
show that the length of the focal chord is
296
1.
2.
3.
4.
18. If a circle cuts a parabola at P, Q, R and S show that PQ and RS are equally
inclined to the axis.
19. The normals at the points P and R on the parabola y2 = 4ax meet on the
parabola at the point P. Show that the locus of the orthocentre of
PQR is y2 = a(x + 6a) and the locus of the circumcentre of PQR is the
parabola 2y = x(x a).
20. Prove that the area of the triangle inscribed in a parabola is twice the area of
the triangle formed by the tangents at the vertices.
21. Prove that any three tangents to a parabola whose slopes are in HP encloses a
triangle of constant area.
297
298
36. Show that the equation of the circle described on the chord intercepted by the
parabola y2 = 4axon the line y = mx + c as diameter is m2(x2 + y2) + 2(mc
2a)x 4ay + c(4am + c) = 0.
37. Circles are described on any two common chords of a parabola as diameter.
Prove that their common chord passes through the vertex of the parabola.
38. If P(h, k) is a fixed point in the plane of a parabola y2 = 4ax. Through P a
variable secant is drawn to cut the parabola in Q and R. T is a point on QR such
that
39. Show that the locus of the point of intersection of tangents, to the parabola y2 =
4ax at points whose ordinates are in the ratio
40. Show that the locus of the middle points of a system of parallel chords of a
parabola is a line which is parallel to the axis of the parabola.
41. P, Q and R are three points on a parabola and the chord PQ meets the diameter
through R in T. Ordinates PM and QN are drawn to this diameter. Show
that RMRN = RT2.
299
Chapter 7
Ellipse
7.1 STANDARD EQUATION
A conic is defined as the locus of a point such that its distance from a fixed
point bears a constant ratio to its distance from a fixed line. The fixed point
is called the focus and the fixed straight line is called the directrix. The
constant ratio is called the eccentricity of the conic. If the eccentricity is less
than unity the conic is called an ellipse. Let us now derive the standard
equation of an ellipse using the above property called focus-directrix
property.
7.2 STANDARD EQUATION OF AN ELLIPSE
Let S be the focus and line l be the directrix. Draw SX perpendicular to the
directrix. Divide SXinternally and externally in the ratio e:1 (e < 1).
Let A and A be the points of division. Since
and
, from the
definition of ellipse, the points A and A lie on the ellipse. Let AA =
2a and C be its middle point.
300
301
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
10. Second focus and second directrix: On the negative side of the origin,
take a point S such that CS = CS and another point X such that CX = CX = a.
of P as
Here S is called the second focus and XM is the
second directrix.
11.
302
The sum of the focal distances of any point on the ellipse is equal
to the length of the major axis.
In the above figure, (section 2.2)
Note 7.3.1:
303
The point P where the ordinate PN meets the auxiliary circle is called the
corresponding point of P. Therefore, the ordinate of any point on the ellipse
to that of corresponding point on the ellipse are in the ratios of lengths of
semi-minor axis and semi-major axis. This ratio gives another definition to
an ellipse. Consider a circle and from each point on it, draw perpendicular
to a diameter.
The locus of these points dividing these perpendiculars in a given ratio is an
ellipse and for this ellipse the given circle is the auxiliary circle.
304
Example 7.1
Find the equation of the ellipse whose foci, directrix and eccentricity are
given below:
1.
Solution
1.
Therefore, the locus of (x1, y1) is the ellipse 101x2 + 81y2 + 48x
330x 324y + 441 = 0.
2.
Therefore, the locus of (x1, y1) is the ellipse 27x2 + 20y2 24xy +
6x + 8y 1 = 0.
3.
305
Therefore, the locus of (x1, y1) is the ellipse 17x2 + 22y2 + 12xy
58x + 108y + 129 = 0.
Example 7.2
Find the equation of the ellipse whose
1.
Solution
1.
is
If the foci are (ae, 0) and (ae, 0) then the equation of the ellipse
Here, ae = 4 and
If the foci are (ae, 0) and (ae, 0) the equation of the ellipse is
Here, ae = 3 and
a2e2 = 9 and
306
9x2 + 4y2 = 36
2. 3x2 + 4y2 12x 8y + 4 = 0
3. 25x2 + 9y2 150x 90y + 225 = 0.
Solution
1.
9x2 + 4y2 = 36
This is an ellipse whose major axis is the y-axis and minor axis is
the x-axis and centre at the origin.
Therefore, eccentricity =
Therefore, foci are
Therefore, latus rectum =
2.
307
Therefore, foci are (3, 1) and (1, 1) with respect to old axes.
Length of the latus rectum
3.
308
2.
3.
x2 + 9y2 = 9
Ans.:
4.
2x2 + 3y2 4x + 6y + 4 = 0
Ans.:
309
2. Find the equation of the ellipse whose foci are (0, 2) and the length of major
axis is 2
Ans.: 5x2 + y2 = 5
3. Find the equation of the ellipse whose foci is (3, 1), eccentricity
is x y + 6 = 0.
and directrix
4. Find the equation of ellipse whose centre is at the origin, one focus is (0, 3) and
the length of semi-major axis is 5.
Ans.:
and directrix
6. Find the equation of the ellipse whose centre is (2, 3), one focus at (3, 3) and
one vertex at (4, 3).
7. Find the coordinates of the centre, eccentricity and foci of the ellipse 8x2 +
6y2 6x + 12y + 13 = 0
Ans.:
8. Find the equation of the ellipse with foci at (0, 1) and (0, 1) and minor axis of
length 1.
9. An ellipse is described by using one endless string which is passed through two
points. If the axes are 6 and 4 units find the necessary length and the distance
between the points.
Ans.:
310
Solving equations (7.6) and (7.7), we get their points of intersection; the xcoordinates of the points of intersection are given by
311
This is a quadratic equation in m and hence there are two values for m. For
each value of m, there is a tangent (real or imaginary) and hence there are
two tangents from a given point to an ellipse. If m1and m2 are the roots of
the equation (7.11), then
If the two tangents are perpendicular then m1m2 = 1.
To find the equation of the chord joining the points (x1, y1) and
(x2, y2) and find the equation of the tangent at (x1, y1) to the
ellipse:
312
Let P(x1, y1) and Q(x2, y2) be two points on the ellipse. Let the equation of
ellipse be
Then
and
Subtracting,
From equation (7.15), we get the equation of the chord joining the points
(x1, y1) and (x2, y2) as:
This chord becomes the tangent at (x1, y1) if Q tends to P and coincides
with P. Hence, by putting x2 =x1 and y2 = y1 in equation (7.16), we get the
equation of the tangent at (x1, y1).
Therefore, the equation of the tangent at (x1, y1) is:
313
However,
Therefore, from equation (7.17), the equation of the tangent at (x1, y1)
is
7.9 EQUATION OF TANGENT AND NORMAL
However,
= slope of the tangent at (x1, y1). Therefore, the equation
of the tangent at (x1, y1) is,
314
is
7.10 EQUATION TO THE CHORD OF CONTACT
Let QR be the chord of contact of tangents from P(x1, y1). Let Q and R be the
points (x2, y2) and (x3,y3), respectively. Then the equation of tangents
at Q and R are:
315
and
The above two equations show that the points (x2, y2) and (x3, y3) lie on the
line
To find the equation of the polar of the point P(x1, y1) on the
ellipse
Let P(x1, y1) be the given point. Let QR be a variable chord through the
point P(x1, y1). Let the tangents at Q and R meet at T(h, k). The equation of
the chord contact from T(h, k) is:
316
Note 7.11.1:
1. When the point (x1, y1) lies on the ellipse, the polar of (x1, y1) is the tangent at
(x1, y1). When the point (x1, y1) lies inside the ellipse the polar of (x1, y1) is the
chord of contact of tangents from (x1, y1).
2. The line
is called the polar of the point (x1, y1) and (x1, y1) is called
Then the equations (7.24) and (7.26) represent the same line.
Identifying equations (7.24) and (7.26), we get
317
The point
Example 7.4
Find the equation of the tangent to the ellipse x2 + 2y2 = 6 at (2, 1).
Solution
The equation of the ellipse is x2 + 2y2 = 6.
(i.e.) 2x 2y = 6 x y = 3
Example 7.5
Find the equation of the normal to the ellipse 3x2 + 2y2 = 5 at (1, 1).
Solution
318
319
Example 7.7
If the tangent at P of the ellipse
meets the major axis
at T and PN is the ordinate of P, then prove that CN CT = a2 where C is the
centre of the ellipse.
Solution
Let P be the point (x1, y1)
The equation of tangent at (x1, y1) is
When the tangent meets the x-axis, y = 0
320
Example 7.8
The tangent at any point P on the ellipse
meets the tangents
at A and A (extremities of major axis) in L and M, respectively. Prove
that AL AM = b2.
Solution
321
Example 7.9
If SY and SY be perpendiculars from the foci upon the tangents at any
point of the ellipse
, then prove that Y, Y lie on the
circle x2 + y2 = a2 and that SY SY = b2.
Solution
(x ae).
322
Cancelling,
The locus of (x1, y1) is x2 + y2 = a2. Similarly, we can prove that the locus of Y
is also this circle. Hence, Y and Y lie on this circle.
Note 7.12.1: This circle is called the auxiliary circle (x2 + y2 = a2). This is
the circle described on the major axis as diameter.
Example 7.10
If normal at a point P on the ellipse
prove that:
1.
CG = e2CN, where C is the centre of the ellipse and N is the foot of the
perpendicular from P to the major axis.
2. SG = eSP where S is the focus of the ellipse.
Solution
1.
323
2.
Example 7.11
In an ellipse, prove that the tangent and normal at any point P are the
external and internal bisectors of the angle SPS where S and S are the foci.
Solution
324
Let the normal at P meet the x-axis at L. The equation of the normal
at P is
When y = 0, x = e2x1
L is (e2x1, 0).
passing
325
326
(i.e.)
Take PA = a and PB = b.
Then x = OQ = RP = b cos, y = QP = b sin,
Hence,
Therefore, the locus of P is an ellipse.
Example 7.14
The equation 25(x2 6x + 9) + 16y2 = 400 represents an ellipse. Find the
centre and foci of the ellipse. How should the axis be transformed so that
the ellipse is represented by the equation
Solution
25(x2 6x + 9) + 16y2 = 400
25(x 3)2 + 16y2 = 400
Dividing by 400,
Take x 3 = X, y = Y.
Then
The major axis of this ellipse is the Y-axis.
327
Foci are S(ae, 0) and S(ae, 0). Vertices are A(a, 0) and A(a, 0), centre is
(0, 0). Any tangent to the ellipse (7.38) is
328
329
Solution
The equation of the ellipse is
Any tangent to the ellipse is
from
.
. The perpendicular distance
to the tangent is
is given by
330
Example 7.18
Let d be the perpendicular distance from the centre of the
ellipse
to the tangent drawn at a point P on the ellipse.
If F1 and F2 are the two foci of the ellipse then show
that
Solution
The equation of the ellipse is
331
Example 7.19
Show that the locus of the middle points of the portion of a tangent to the
ellipse
Solution
Any tangent to the ellipse
is
332
and
meets the
Solution
Any tangent to the ellipse
is
333
Equations (7.48) and (7.49) represent the same line. Identifying equations
Therefore,
The locus of (x1, y1) is the equation of the
director circle of the ellipse(7.49). However, director circle is the
intersection of perpendicular tangents. Hence, the tangents atQ and R are
at right angles.
Example 7.21
A chord PQ of an ellipse subtends a right angle at the centre of the
ellipse
334
Since
, coefficient of x2 + coefficient of y2 = 0.
of any
335
Dividing by
The locus of (x1, y1) is
Example 7.23
Show that the locus of poles of tangents to the circle (x h)2 +
(y k)2 = r2 with respect to the ellipse
is
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the pole with respect to the ellipse
(x1, y1) is
This line is a tangent to the circle (x h)2 + (y k)2 = r2.
The condition for this is that the radius of the circle should be equal to the
perpendicular distance from the centre on the tangents.
336
The condition is
The polar of
337
Solution
Let the equation of the ellipse be
The ends of major axis are A(a, 0) and A(a, 0). Any tangent to the ellipse
is
The
This circle passes through the foci S(ae, 0) and S(ae, 0).
Example 7.26
The ordinate NP of a point P on the ellipse is produced to meet the tangent
at one end of the latus rectum through the focus S in Q. Prove that QN = SP.
338
Solution
Let LSL be the latus rectum through the focus S. The equation of tangent
at L is
or
y1 = a ex1
QN = a ex1
339
When the tangent and normal meet in the minor axis in T and Q,
respectively, the coordinates of Tand Q are T
and
340
Solution
The equation of ellipse is
SS = 2ae
Let
Then
341
Hence,
Example 7.29
A variable point P on the ellipse of eccentricity e is joined to its
foci S and S. Prove that the locus of the incentre of the PSS is an ellipse
whose eccentricity is
Solution
Let the equation of the ellipse be
The coordinates of the foci are S(ae, 0) and S( ae, 0). Let P(h, k) be any
point on the ellipse. ThenSP + SP = 2a.
Also SS = 2ae. Also SP = a e h, SP = a + e k.
Let the coordinates of the incentre be (x1, y1). Then
342
Ans.:
2. Find the length of latus rectum, eccentricity, equation of the directrix and foci
of the ellipse 25x2+ 16y2 = 400.
Ans.:
343
Ans.: 2,2
,(2,1),(2,3), 2 ,x 2 = 0, y 1 = 0
4. Prove that
touches the ellipse
of the point of contact.
Ans.:
5. If p be the length of the perpendicular from the focus S of the
ellipse
on the tangents atP then show that
6. If ST be the perpendicular from the focus S on the tangent at any point P on the
ellipse
subtends a
on the ellipse
9. P is a point on the ellipse
and Q, the corresponding point on the
auxiliary circle. If the tangent at P to the ellipse cuts the minor axis in T, then
prove that the line QT touches the auxiliary circle.
10. Tangents to the ellipse
make angles 1 and 2 with the major axis.
Find the equation of the locus of their intersection when tan (1 + 2) is a
constant.
11. Show that the locus of the point of intersection of two perpendicular tangents
to an ellipse is a circle.
12. Prove that a chord of an ellipse is divided harmonically by any point on it and
its pole with respect to the ellipse.
13. If the polar of P with respect to an ellipse passes through the point Q, show that
polar of Qpasses through P.
344
14. Find the condition for the pole of the straight line lx + my = 1 with respect to
the ellipse
Ans.: a l + b m = 4
2 2
. Show that
345
and the
. Prove
are concurrent.
at right angles
346
39. If RP and RQ are tangents from an external point R(x1, y1) to the
ellipse
We know that
is called the eccentric angle and it is also called the parameter of the
point P.
347
Dividing by ab,
Therefore, the equation of the chord joining the points whose eccentric
angles are is
Note 7.14.1: This chord becomes the tangent at if =
The equation of the tangent at is
348
Dividing by ab,
349
is
7.16 CONORMAL POINTS
This is a fourth degree equation in t and hence there are four values
for t. For each value of t, there is a value of and hence there are four
values of say , , , and . Hence, there are four normals from a given
point to an ellipse.
Hence,
350
A circle and an ellipse will cut four points and that the sum of the eccentric
angles of the four points of intersection is an even multiple of .
Let the equation of the ellipse be
Any point on the ellipse is (a cos b, a sin). When the circle and the ellipse
intersect, this point lies on the circle.
351
Equation (7.68) is a fourth degree equation in t and hence there are four
values for t, real or imaginary.
For each value of t there corresponds a value of . Hence in general there
are four points of intersection of a circle and an ellipse with eccentric
angles 1, 2, 3, and 4.
We know that,
352
Let R(x1, y1) be the midpoint of a chord PQ of this ellipse. Let the equation
of chord PQ be
Any point on this line is (x1 + rcos, y1 + r sin ). When the chord meets the
ellipse this point lies on the ellipse (7.69).
If R(x1, y1) is the midpoint of the chord PQ then the two values of r are the
distances PR and RQwhich are equal in magnitude but opposite in sign.
The condition for this is the coefficient of r = 0.
Substituting
353
The two values of r are the distances of the point of intersection of the
chord and the ellipse from (x1,y1). The line will become a tangent if the two
values of r are equal. The condition for this is the discriminant of the
quadratic equation is zero.
354
This is the combined equation of the pair of tangents from (x1, y1).
Note 7.19.1: The combined equation of the pair of tangents from the point
(x1, y1) is
355
Example 7.30
Find the condition that the line lx + my + n = 0 may be a tangent to the
ellipse
Solution
Let lx + my + n = 0 be a tangent to the ellipse
356
Solution
The equation of the ellipse is
357
358
which is an ellipse.
Example 7.33
Show that the locus of poles of normal chords of the
ellipse
is
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the pole of the normal chord of the ellipse
Let this be normal at on the ellipse of equation (7.84). Then the equation
of the normal at is
359
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the midpoint of a chord of the ellipse which is normal at .
The equation of the chord in terms of its middle point is
360
that tan
Solution
The equation of the chord joining the points whose eccentric angles
are and
361
This line meets the major axis at the point (d, 0).
Example 7.36
The tangent at the point on the ellipse meet auxiliary circle on two points
which subtend a right angle at the centre. Show that the eccentricity of the
ellipse is (1 + sin2 )1/2.
Solution
362
coefficient of x2 + coefficient of y2 = 0
Example 7.37
If the normal at the end of a latus rectum of an ellipse passes through one
extremity of the minor axis, show that the eccentricity of the curve is given
by e4 + e2 1 = 0.
Solution
Let the equation of the ellipse be
363
The equation of
the normal at L is
This normal passes at the point
Example 7.38
Prove that the tangent and normal at a point on the ellipse bisect the angle
between the focal radii of that point.
Solution
Let the equation of the ellipse be
Let PT and PQ be the tangent and normal at any point P on the ellipse. The
equation of the normal at (x1, y1) is
364
is
Solution
The equation of the ellipse is
Let (x1, y1) be the midpoint of a chord of the ellipse of equation (7.87).
365
Since
, coefficient of x2 + coefficient of y2 = 0.
Example 7.40
Prove that the portion of the tangent to the ellipse intercepted between the
curve and the directrix subtends a right angle at the corresponding focus.
Solution
366
. The equation of
The slope of SP is
The slope of ST is
Example 7.41
367
Therefore, P is
When it meets y-axis, x = 0.
Therefore, Q is
C is (0, 0).
Slope of the normal =
sq. units.
368
Example 7.42
If is a constant, prove that the chord joining the points, and
touches a fixed ellipse.
Solution
The equation of the chord joining the points and is
Take
= cos k.
369
Solution
Example 7.44
If the normal to the ellipse
2 show that cos
370
Solution
The equation of the ellipse is
a2 = 14, b2 = 5
The equation of the normal at is
Example 7.45
If the normal at any point P to the ellipse
meets the major and
minor axes in G and g and ifCF be the perpendicular upon this normal,
where C is the centre of the ellipse, then prove that PF Pg = a2 and PF
PG = b2.
Solution
371
Let P(a cos, b sin) be any point on the ellipse. Let the normal at P meet
the major axis in G and minor axis in g. Let CF be the perpendicular
from C to the normal at P. The equations of the tangent and normal at P are
and
372
Example 7.46
Show that the condition for the normals at the points (xi, yi), i = 1, 2, 3 on
the ellipse
to be concurrent is
Solution
Let (h, k) be the point of concurrence of the normal. The equation of the
normal at
Since this normal passes through (h, k),
373
Similarly,
Example 7.47
Show that the area of the triangle inscribed in an ellipse
is
are the eccentric angles of the
vertices and hence find the condition that the area of the triangle inscribed
in an ellipse is maximum.
Solution
Let ABC be inscribed in the ellipse
374
Let A, B and C be the points (a cos , b sin ), (a cos , b sin ) and (a cos ,
b sin ), respectively. Then the area of the ABC is given by,
Area of ABC is the greatest when the area of ABC is the greatest.
However, the area of ABC is the greatest when the triangle is equilateral.
In this case the eccentric angles of the points P, Q and Rare
(i.e.) The eccentric angles of the points P, Q and R differ by
Example 7.48
If three of the sides of a quadrilateral inscribed in an ellipse are in a fixed
direction, show that the fourth side of the quadrilateral is also in a fixed
direction.
375
Solution
Let , , and be the eccentric angles of the vertices of the
quadrilateral ABCD inscribed in the ellipse
constant.
Similarly,
Solution
376
377
Exercises
1. If and be the eccentric angles at the extremities of a chord of an ellipse of
eccentricity e, prove that cos
2. Let P and Q be two points on the major axis of an ellipse
equidistant
from the centre. Chords are drawn through P and Q meeting the ellipse at
points whose eccentric angles are , , g and . Then prove that tan
whose eccentric
Ans.:
378
5. P and P are the corresponding points on an ellipse and its auxiliary circle.
Prove that the tangents at P and P intersect on the major axis.
6. The tangent at one end P of a diameter PP of an ellipse and any
chord PQ through the other end meet at R. Prove that the tangent
at Q bisects PR.
7. Prove that the three ellipses
will have a
common tangent if
8. Any tangent to the ellipse is cut by the tangents at the ends of the major axis
in T and T. Prove that the circle on TT as diameter will pass through the foci.
9. Find the coordinates of the points on the ellipse
, the tangents at
which will make equal angles with the axis. Also prove that the length of the
perpendicular from the centre on either of these is
Ans.:
10. Find the condition for the line x cos + y sin = p is a tangent to the
ellipse
379
15. If the normal at a point P on the ellipse of semi-axes a, b and centre C cuts the
major and minor axes at G and g, show that a2Cg2 + b2CG2 = (a2 b2)2. Also
prove that PG = eGN, where PN is the ordinate of P.
16. The tangents and normal at a point P on the ellipse
meet the major
axis in T and T so that TT = a. Prove that the eccentric angle of P is given
by e2cos2 + cos 1 = 0.
17. Prove that, the line joining the extremities of any two perpendicular diameters
of an ellipse always touches a concentric circle.
18. Show that the locus of the foot of the perpendicular drawn from the centre of
the ellipse
21. If the normals at the four points (xi, yi), i = 1, 2, 3, 4 on the ellipse
are
are concurrent
380
27. Find the locus of the midpoint of chords of the ellipse of constant length 2l.
, tangents at
touching the
381
37. If the normals to an ellipse at Pi, i = 1, 2, 3, 4 are concurrent then the circle
through P1, P2 and P3meets the ellipse again in a point P4 which is the other end
of the diameter through P4.
38. Find the centre of the circle passing through the three points, on the ellipse
whose eccentric angles are , and .
39. If ABC be a maximum triangle inscribed in an ellipse then show that the
eccentric angles of the vertices differ by
and the normals A, B and C are
concurrent.
40. The tangent and normal to the ellipse x2 + 4y2 = 2, at the point P meet the
major axis in Q andR, respectively and QR = 2. Show that the eccentric angle
of P is cos1
41. If two concentric ellipses be such that the foci of one lie on the other then prove
that the angle between their axes is
eccentricities.
42. Show that the length of the focal chord of the ellipse
which makes an
382
47. If the angle between the diameter of any point of the ellipse
and the
383
Its slope is
Since this chord is parallel to y = mx,
The locus of (x1, y1) is
which is a straight line passing through the
centre of the ellipse. If y =m1x bisect all chords parallel
to y = mx then
By symmetry of this result, we see that the diameter y = mx bisect all the
chords parallel to y = m1x.
Definition 7.20.1 Two diameters are said to be conjugate to each other if
chords parallel to one is bisected by the other. Therefore, the condition for
the diameter y = mx and y = m1x to be conjugate diameters is
7.20.2 Property: The Eccentric Angles of the Extremities of a Pair of Semiconjugate Diameter Differ by a Right Angle
384
Let PCP and DCD be a pair of conjugate diameters. Let P be the points
(a cos, b sin) and D be the points (a cos, b sin). Then the slope
of CP is
The slope of CD is
Since CP and CD are semi-conjugate diameters
385
Then
Let PCP and DCD be a pair of conjugate diameters. Let P be the point
(a cos, b sin). Then D is the point
386
387
7.20.6 Property: If PCP and DCD are Conjugate Diameter then They are also
Conjugate Lines
We know that the polar of a point and the chord of contact of tangents from
it to the ellipse are the same. Therefore, the pole of the diameter PCP will
be the point of intersection of the tangents at Pand P which are parallel.
Therefore, the pole of PCP lies at infinity on the conjugate diameter DCD.
Hence, PCP and DCD are conjugate lines.
Note 7.20.2: Conjugate diameter is a special case of conjugate lines.
7.21 EQUI-CONJUGATE DIAMETERS
388
When
When
are
Therefore, the equi-conjugate diameters are
which are
the equations of the diagonals formed by the tangents at the four vertices of
the ellipse.
ILLUSTRATIVE EXAMPLES BASED ON CONJUGATE DIAMETERS
Example 7.50
Show that the locus of the point of intersection of tangents at the
extremities of a pair of conjugate diameters of the ellipse
is the
ellipse
Solution
Let PCP and DCD be a pair of conjugate diameters of the ellipse
Let P be the point (a cos b sin).
389
Let (x1, y1) be the point of intersection of the tangents at P and D. The
equations of the tangents at Pand D are
and
390
Example 7.52
If CP and CD are two conjugate semi-diameters of an ellipse
then
The
391
(i.e)
where
This straight line touches the ellipse
Example 7.53
Find the condition that the two straight lines represented by Ax2 +
2Hxy + By2 = 0 may be a pair of conjugate diameters of the ellipse
Solution
Let the two straight lines represented by Ax2 + 2Hxy + By2 = 0
be y = m1x and y = m2x. Then
The condition for the lines to be conjugate diameters is
392
The equation of the line perpendicular to this and passing through the
centre (0, 0) is
Let (x1, y1) be the foot of the perpendicular from (0, 0) on PD.
Then (x1, y1) lies on the above two lines.
Solving for
Substituting for
and
, we get
and
393
Solution
Let P be the point (a cos, b sin). Then D is the point
(a sin, b cos). C is the point (0, 0).
The equations of the circles on CP and CD as diameters are x(x a cos)
+ y(y b sin) = 0 and x(x+ a sin) + y(y b cos) = 0.
and
be the
and
394
is
or
Example 7.57
If and be the angles subtended by the major axis of an ellipse at the
extremities of a pair of conjugate diameters then show that cos2 + cos2 is
a constant.
Solution
Let equation of the ellipse be
395
The slope of AP is
The slope of AP is
Changing a into + ,
Example 7.58
If x cos + y sin = p is a chord joining the ends P and D of conjugate
semi-diameters of the ellipse then prove that a2 cos2 + b2 sin2 = 2p2.
Solution
396
The equation of PD is
Example 7.59
CP and CD are conjugate diameters of the ellipse
. A tangent is
drawn parallel to PD meetingCP and CD in R and S respectively. Prove
that R and S lie on the ellipse
397
Solution
Let CP and CD be a pair of conjugate diameters of the ellipse
Let P be the point (a cos, b sin). Then D is the point (a sin, b cos).
Slope of PD is
398
Dividing by a2b2,
The locus of (h, k) is
point S also lies on the above ellipse.
Similarly, the
Example 7.60
A tangent to the ellipse
cuts the circle x2 + y2 = a2 + b2 in P and Q.
Prove that CP and CQ are along conjugates semi-diameters of the ellipse
where C is the centre of the circle.
Solution
The equation of the ellipse is
(7.125)
399
400
401
402
Example 7.64
Let P and Q be the extremities of two conjugate diameters of the
ellipse
and S be the focus. Then prove that PQ2 (SP SQ)2 = 2b2.
Solution
Let S be (ae, 0) and P be (a cos, b sin).
Then SP = a aecos, SQ = a + aesin.
403
Example 7.65
If CP and CD are semi-conjugate diameters of the ellipse
that the lotus of the orthocentre of PCD is 2(b2y2 + a2x2)3 =
(a2 b2)2 (a2x2 b2y2)2.
, prove
Solution
404
Ans.:
405
406
21. Show that the maximum value of the smaller of two angles between two
conjugate diameters of an ellipse is
is
respectively.
22. If PCP and DCD are two conjugate diameters of the ellipse
and Q is any point on the circle x2 + y2 = c2 then prove
that PQ2 + DQ2 + P2Q2 + PQ2 = 2(a2 + b2 + 2c2).
28. Show that ax2 + 2hxy by2 = 0 represents conjugate diameters of the
ellipse ax2 + by2 = 1 for all values of a.
29. Prove that ax2 + 2hxy by2 = 0 represents conjugate diameters of the
ellipse ax2 + by2 = 1 for all values of h.
30. CP and CQ are conjugate semi-diameters of the ellipse
. A tangent
parallel to PQ meetsCP and CQ in R and S, respectively. Show that R and S lie
on the ellipse
31. If two conjugate diameters CP and CQ of an ellipse cut the director circle
in L and M, prove thatLM touches the ellipse.
32. Two conjugate diameters of the ellipse
cuts the
circle x2 + y2 = r at P and Q. Show that the locus of the midpoint
of PQ is a2[(x2 + y2)2 r2x2] + b2[(x2 + y2)2 r2y2] = 0.
407
Ans.:
408
45. Prove that the straight lines joining the centre to the intersection of the straight
line
409
Chapter 8
Hyperbola
8.1 DEFINITION
Let S be the focus and the line l be the directrix. Draw SX perpendicular to
the directrix. Divide SXinternally and externally in the ratio e : 1 (e > 1).
Let A and A be the point of division. Since
points A and A lie on the curve.
Let AA = 2a and C be its middle point.
and
the
410
411
The difference of the focal distances of any point on the hyperbola is equal
to the length of transverse axis.
412
The foci are S(ae, 0) and S(ae, 0) and the equations of the directrices
are
By the symmetry of the hyperbola, if we take the transverse axis
as the y-axis and the conjugate axis as x-axis, then the equation of the
hyperbola is
This hyperbola is called the conjugate hyperbola. Here, the coordinates of
the foci are S(0, be) and S (0, be). The equations of the directrices
are
The length of the transverse axis is 2b.
The length of the conjugate axis is 2a.
The length of the latus rectum is
The following are some of the standard results of the hyperbola
whose equation is
1. The equation of the tangent at (x 1, y1) is
2. The equation of the normal at (x1, y1) is
3. The equation of the chord of contact of tangents from (x1, y1) is
4. The polar of (x1, y1) is
5. The condition that the straight line y = mx + c is a tangent to the hyperbola
is c2 = a2m2 b2and
is the equation of a tangent.
413
6. The equation of the chord of the hyperbola having (x1, y1) as the midpoint
is
7. The equation of the pair of tangents from (x1, y1)
is T2 = SS1
8. Parametric representation: x = a sec , y = b tan is a point on the
hyperbola and this point is denoted by . is called a parameter of the
hyperbola.
Example 8.6.1
Find the equation of the hyperbola whose focus is (1, 2), directrix 2x + y = 1
and eccentricity
Solution
Let P(x1, y1) be any point on the hyperbola. Then
414
and
3x 4y = 1
Solution
S is (2,2) :
hyperbola.
415
and
x cos + y sin = p
Solution
416
Example 8.6.6
Find the equation of the hyperbola whose center is (3, 2), one end of the
transverse axis is (3, 4) and eccentricity is
Solution
Centre is (3, 4)
A is (3, 4) A is (3, 6); a = 2
Example 8.6.7
417
Find the equation of the hyperbola whose centre is (1, 0), one focus is (6, 0),
and length of transverse axis is 6.
Solution
Example 8.6.8
Find the equation of the hyperbola whose centre is (3, 2), one focus is (5, 2)
and one vertex is (4, 2).
Solution
C is (3, 2), A is (4, 2) and S is (5, 2).
Hence, CA = 1and the transverse axis is parallel to x-axis.
a=1
Example 8.6.9
418
Find the equation of the hyperbola whose centre is (6, 2), one focus is (4, 2)
and e = 2.
Solution
Transverse axis is parallel to x-axis and CS = 2 units in magnitude.
419
420
Example 8.6.13
If from the centre C of the hyperbola x2 y2 = a2, CM is drawn
perpendicular to the tangent at any point of the curve meeting the tangent
at M and the curve at N, show that CM CN = a2.
Solution
The equation of the tangent at P (x1, y1) in x2 y2 = a2 is xx1 yy1 = a2.
421
Example 8.6.14
Tangents to the hyperbola make angles 1, 2 with the transverse axis. Find
the equation of the locus of point of intersection such that tan (1 + 2) is a
constant.
Solution
Let the equation of the hyperbola be
which make
422
Solution
The tangent drawn from any point to the ellipse
is
Hence, the two tangents make complementary angles with the axes.
Example 8.6.16
Chords of the hyperbola
Find the locus of their poles.
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the pole with respect to hyperbola
(x1, y1) is
is
. The polar of
423
and
Solution
The two given hyperbolas are
and
c2 = a2 m2 b2
and
Example 8.6.18
Show that the locus of midpoints of normal chords of the
hyperbola x2 y2 = a2 is
424
whose centre is
Solution
The equation of the hyperbola is
425
The equation of the chord of the hyperbola in terms of its middle point
is
Since this chord passes through the fixed point (h, k),
, which is a hyperbola
whose centre is
Example 8.6.20
Show that the locus of the foot of the perpendicular from the centre upon
any normal to the hyperbola
Solution
Let P (a sec , b tan ) be a point on the hyperbola. Let m (x1, y1) be the foot
of the perpendicular from the centre with normal at P. The equation of the
normal at P is
426
427
428
429
. The coordinates
Then,
. Its
430
When this line meets the transverse axis, y = 0 and x = a cos. Here Q is
(a cos , 0). When it meets the line x = a,
431
Hence, the locus of (h, k) is b2x + 4xy2 = ab2 or x(b2 + 4y2 ) = ab2.
Example 8.6.26
Show that the locus of the midpoints of the chords of the
hyperbola
is
Solution
Let P(x1, y1) be the midpoint of a chord of the hyperbols
432
Example 8.6.27
From points on the circle x2 y2 = a2 tangents are drawn to the
hyperbola x2 y2 = a2. Prove that the locus of the middle points of the
chords of contact is the curve (x2 y2) = a2 (x2 + y2).
Solution
Let P (x1, y1) be a point on the circle x2 + y2 = a2.
433
xx1 yy1 = a2
xh yk = h2 k
These two equations represent the same line. Identifying them, we get
434
are
These two lines meet the conjugate axis at Q and R. Therefore substitute x =
0 in equations (8.3) and(8.4). The coordinates of Q are
The
coordinates of R are
The equation of the circle with QR as diameter is
Substituting x = ae and y = 0
435
2. Show that the equation of the hyperbola having focus (2, 0), eccentricity 2 and
directrix x y = 0 is x2 + y2 4xy + 4 = 0.
3. Find the equation of the hyperbola whose focus is (2, 2), eccentricity
directrix 3x 4y = 1.
and
4. Find the equation of the hyperbola whose focus is (0, 0), eccentricity
directrix x cos + ysin = p.
and
5. Find the equation of the hyperbola whose centre is (3, 2) and one end of the
transverse axis is (3, 4) and eccentricity is .
Ans.:
7. Find the equation of the hyperbola whose centre is (1, 0), one focus is (6, 0)
and length of transverse axis is 6.
8. Find the equation of the hyperbola whose centre is (3, 2), one focus is (5, 2)
and one vertex is (4, 2).
9. Find the equation of the hyperbola whose centre is (6, 2), one focus is (4, 2)
and eccentricity 2.
Ans.:
10. Find the centre, eccentricity and foci of hyperbola 9x2 16y2 = 144.
Ans.:
436
11. Find the centre, foci and eccentricity of 12x2 4y2 24x + 32y 127 = 0.
12. Find the centre, foci and eccentricity of the hyperbola 9x2 4y2 18x + 16y
43 = 0.
Ans.:
13. If S and S are the foci of a hyperbola and p is any point on the hyperbola, show
that SP SP = 2a.
14. Find the latus of the hyperbola
Ans.:
15. Find the equation of the hyperbola referred to its axis as the axis of coordinate
if length of transverse axis is 5 and conjugate axis is 4.
Ans.:
16. Find the latus rectum of the hyperbola 4x 9y2 = 36.
Ans.:
17. Find the centre, eccentricity and foci of the hyperbola x2 2y2 2x + 8y 1 =
0.
Ans.:
18. Find the centre, eccentricity, foci and directrix of the hyperbola 16x2 9y2 +
32x + 36y 164 = 0.
Ans.:
Find a and b.
437
Ans.:
20. Tangents are drawn to the hyperbola 3x2 2y2 = 6 from the point P and
make 1,2 with x-axis. If the tan 1 tan 2 is a constant, prove that locus of P is
2x2 y2 = 7.
21. Find the equation of tangents to the hyperbola 3x2 4y2 = 15 which are parallel
to y = 2x + k.Find the coordinates of the point of contact.
Ans.:
22. Tangents are drawn to the hyperbola x2 y2 = c2 are inclined at an angle of 45,
show that the locus of their intersection is (x2 + y2)2 + 4a2 (x2 y2) = 4a4.
23. Prove that the polar of any point on the ellipse
with respect to
the
will touch the ellipse at the other end of the ordinate through
the point.
24. If the polar of points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) with respect to hyperbola are at right
angles then show that b4x1x2 + a4y1y2 = 0.
25. Find the locus of poles of normal chords of the hyperbola
Ans.:
28. Obtain the locus of the point of intersection of tangents to the
hyperbola
438
are
hyperbola
touches
36. Obtain the equation of the chord joining the points and on the hyperbola in
the form
439
Ans.:
41. Tangents are drawn from any point on hyperbola x2 y2 = a2 + b2 to the
hyperbola
. Prove that they meet the axes in conjugate points.
42. Prove that the part of the tangent at any point of a hyperbola intercepted
between the point of contact and the transverse axis is a harmonic mean
between the lengths of the perpendiculars drawn from the foci on the normal at
the same point.
43. If the chord joining the points and on the hyperbola
is a focal
that
8.7 ASYMPTOTES
440
by
Therefore, the hyperbola and the conjugate hyperbola have the
same asymptotes.
2. The equation of the hyperbola is
441
and
Hence, they are equally inclined to the coordinate axes, which are the
transverse and conjugate axes.
8.7.2 Angle between the Asymptotes
442
Solution
The combined equation of the asymptotes should differ from that of the
hyperbola only by a constant term.
The combined equation of the asymptotes is
Equating the coefficients of the terms x and y and the constant terms, we
get
lm = k
443
(x + l)(y + m) = xy xh yk n
Equating the coefficients of the terms x and y and the constant terms, we
get
Example 8.7.4
Find the equation of the hyperbola that has 3x 4y + 7 = 0 and 4x + 3y + 1
= 0 as asymptotes and passes through the origin.
Solution
444
Example 8.7.5
Find the equations of the asymptotes and the conjugate hyperbola given
that the hyperbola has eccentricity , focus at the origin and the directrix
along x + y + 1 = 0.
Solution
From the focus directrix property, the equation of the hyperbola is
445
Example 8.7.6
Derive the equations of asymptotes.
Solution
The equation of the hyperbola is
(i.e.) f (x1, y1)
2
2
2
2
2
2
= b x a y a b = 0. This being a second-degree equation, it can have
maximum two asymptotes. As the coefficients of the highest degree terms
in x and y are constants, there is no asymptote parallel to the axes of
coordinates. Take x = 1 and y = m in the highest degree
terms (m)= b2 a2m2. Similarly (m) = 0. The slopes of the oblique
asymptotes are given by 2(m) = 0. (i.e.)
Also,
446
Ans.: (x + 2y 13)(3x + 4y + 3) 8 = 0
6. Find the asymptotes of the hyperbola 3x2 5xy 2y2 + 5x + 11y 8 = 0.
Ans.: x 2y + 3 = 0 3x + y 4 = 0
7. Prove that the locus of the centre of the circle circumscribing the triangle
formed by the asymptotes of the hyperbola
is
8. Find the equation of the asymptotes of the hyperbola 9y2 4x2 = 36 and obtain
the product of the perpendicular distance of any point on the hyperbola from
the asymptotes.
9. Show that the locus of the point of intersection of the asymptotes with the
directrices of the hyperbola
is the circle x2 + y2 = a2.
10. Let C be the centre of a hyperbola. The tangent at P meets the axes
in Q and R and the asymptotes in L and M. The normal at P meets the axes
in A and B. Prove that L and M lie on the circle OAB and Q and R are conjugate
with respect to the circle.
11. If a line through the focus S drawn parallel to the asymptotes
of the
hyperbola
meets the hyperbola and the corresponding directrix
at P and Q then show that SQ = 2 SP.
12. Find the asymptotes of the hyperbola
and show that the straight line
parallel to an asymptote will meet the curve in one point at infinity.
13. Prove that the product of the intercepts made by any tangent to a hyperbola on
its asymptotes is a constant.
14. If a series of hyperbolas is drawn having a common transverse axis of length
2a then prove that the locus of a point P on each hyperbola, such that its
distance from one asymptote is the curve (x2 b2)2 = 4x2(x2 a2).
8.8 CONJUGATE DIAMETERS
447
Then
since
Property 8.8.1
If a diameter meets a hyperbola in real points, it will meet the conjugate
hyperbola in imaginary points and its conjugate diameter will meet the
448
449
The conjugate diameter meets the hyperbola in imaginary points. Also its
intersection with the conjugate hyperbola is given by
450
Proof
Let P and D be points (a sec , b tan ) and (a tan , b sec ) on the
hyperbola and its conjugate.
respectively. Clearly the tangents at P and P are parallel and also the
tangents at D and D are parallel. Solving (8.9) and (8.11) we get the
coordinates of D are [a(sec + tan ), b[sec + tan )].
This lies on the asymptote
451
Lines (8.11), (8.12) and (8.13) are parallel and also the
lines (8.9), (8.10) and (8.11) are parallel.
Therefore, area of parallelogram ABCD = 4 area of parallelogram CPAD.
Example 8.8.1
If a pair of conjugate diameters meet hyperbola and its conjugate,
respectively in P and D then prove that PD is parallel to one of the
asymptotes and is bisected by the other asymptote.
Solution
Let the equation of the hyperbola be
452
453
or 32x 9y = 0.
Example 8.8.3
Find the condition that the pair of lines Ax2 + 2Hxy + By2 = 0 to be
conjugate diameters of the hyperbola
Solution
Let the two straight lines represented by Ax2 + 2Hxy + By2 = 0
be y = m1x and y = m2x. Then
Property 8.8.4
Any two conjugate diameters of a rectangular hyperbola are equally
inclined to the asymptotes.
Proof
Let the equation of the rectangular hyperbola be x2 y2 = a2. The equation
of the asymptotes is x2 y2 = 0.
454
Let y = mx and
be a pair of conjugate diameters of the rectangular
hyperbola be x2 y2 = a3.
Then the combined equation of the conjugate diameters is
The combined equation of the bisectors of the angles between these two
lines is
455
or xy = c2 where
456
since
x1y1 = c2.
The slope of the normal at (x1, y1) is
The equation of the normal at (x1, y1) is
on the Rectangular
is
457
Dividing by t, we get
8.9.4 Equation of the Chord Joining the Points t1 and t2 on the Rectangular
Hyperbola xy = c2and the Equation of the Tangent at t
The two points are
two points are
458
The combined equation of the bisectors of the angles between these two
lines is
which is the combined equation of the
asymptotes. Therefore, the asymptotes bisect the angle between the
conjugate diameter.
8.9.6 Results Concerning the Rectangular Hyperbola
1. The equation of the tangent at (x1, y1) on the rectangular
hyperbola xy = c2 is
2. The equation of the normal at (x1, y1) is
3. The equation of the pair of tangents from (x1, y1) is (xy1 + yx1 2c2)2 =
4(xy c2)(x1y1 c2).
4. The equations of the chord having (x1, y1) as its midpoint is xy1 + yx1 = 2x1y1.
5. The equation of the chord of contact from (x1, y1) is xy1 + yx1 = 2c2.
459
in the
460
Let (x1, y1) be the pole with respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax. Then, the polar
of (x1, y1) is
This is a tangent to the rectangular hypherbola x2 y2 = a2.
The condition for tangency is
461
Since
The locus of (h, k) is (x2 y2)2 = a2(x2 + y2).
Example 8.9.3
Prove that the locus of poles of all normal chords of the rectangular
hyperbola xy = c2 is the curve (x2 y2) + 4c2xy = 0.
Solution
Let (x1, y1) be the pole of the normal chord of rectangular hyperbola xy = c2.
The poles of (x1, y1) is xy1 + yx1 = 2c2. Let the chord be normal at t. The
equation of the normal at t is
These two equations represent
the same straight line. Identifying them, we get
Also
462
The condition is
463
464
465
466
The equation of the chord joining the points t and t1 is x + y t t1 = c(t + t1).
These two equations represent the same straight line. Identifying them, we
get
Example 8.9.10
Show that the area of the triangle formed by the two asymptotes of the
rectangular hyperbola xy = c2and the normal at (x1, y1) on the hyperbola
is
Solution
The equation of the normal at (x1, y1) is
467
(i.e.)
Example 8.9.11
If four points be taken on a rectangular hyperbola such that the chord
joining any two is perpendicular to the chord joining the other two
and , , , are the inclinations of the straight lines joining these points to
the centre. prove that tan tan tan tan = 1.
Solution
468
Let t1, t2, t3, and t4 be four points P, Q, R, and S on the rectangular
hyperbola xy = c2. The equation of the chord joining t1 and t2 is x + yt1t2 = c
(t1 + t2).
The slope of this chord is
Similarly, the slope of the chord joining t3 and t4 is
Since these two chords are perpendicular,
This is a cubic equation in t. If t1, t2 and t3 are the roots of this equation they
can be regarded as the parameters of the points P, Q and R, the normals at
these points meet at t' which is S. From equation (8.27), we get t1 + t2 + t3 =
0 and t1t2 + t2t3 + t3t1 = 0. Let (h, k) be the centroid of PQR.
469
Then
is t1t2t3t4 = 1.
470
Example 8.9.14
Prove that from any point (h, k) four normals can be drawn to the
rectangular hyperbola xy = c2 and that if the coordinates of the four feet of
the normals P, Q, R and S be (xr, yr), r = 1,2,3,4. Then
(i) x1 +x2 + x3 + x4 = h, y1 + y2 + y3 + y4 = k and (ii) x1x2x3x4 = y1y2y3y4 = c4.
Solution
The equation of the normal at t is
The form values of t correspond to the feet of the four normals from the
point (h, k). If t1, t2, t3 and t4are the four feet of the normals then they are the
roots of the above equation.
(i.e.) x1 + x2 + x3 + x4 = h
471
Example 8.9.15
Prove that the feet of the concurrent normals on the rectangular
hyperbola xy = c2 which meets at (h, k) lie on another rectangular hyperbola
which passes through (0,0) and (h, k).
Solution
The equation of the normal at (x1, y1) is
Since this passes through (h, k),
The locus of (x1, y1) is x2 y2 hx + ky = 0. Clearly this is a rectangular
hyperbola passing through (0,0) and (h, k).
Example 8.9.16
If a rectangular hyperbola whose centre is c is cut by any circle of radius r in
four points P, Q, R, Sthen prove that CP2 + CQ2 + CR2 + CS2 = 4r2.
Solution
Let the equation of the rectangular hyperbola be
472
Example 8.9.17
A, B, C and D are four points of intersection of a circle and a rectangular
hyperbola. If AB passes through the centre of the hyperbola, show
that CD passes through the centre of the circle.
Solution
Let the equation of the rectangular hyperbola be xy = c2. Let the equation of
the circle be x2 + y2 + 2gx + 2 fy + k = 0. Let A, B, C and D be the
points t1,t2,t3 and t4, respectively. When the circle and rectangular hyperbola
intersect we know that
473
t1+ t2 =0
(8.38)
474
Let p be the point (h, k ). Since the normal passes through (h,
k ),
This brings a fourth degree equation, there are four normals from P.
If t1, t2, t3 and t4 are the feet of the normals then
Example 8.9.19
The slopes of the sides of triangle ABC inscribed in a rectangular
hyperbola xy = c2 are tan , tan and tan . If the normals at A, B and C are
concurrent show that cot 2 + cot 2 + cot 2 = 0.
Solution
Let A, B, C be the points t1, t2 and t3 respectively.
The slope of AB is
475
Example 8.9.20
Show that an infinite number of triangles can be inscribed in a rectangular
hyperbola xy = c2 whose sides touch the parabola y2 = 4ax.
Solution
Let ABC be a triangle inscribed in the rectangular hyperbola xy = c2.
Let A,B and C be the points t1, t2, and t3, respectively. Suppose the
sides AB and AC touch the parabola y2 = 4ax. The equation of the
chord AB is x + yt1t2 = c(t1 + t2).
This touches the parabola y2 = 4ax. (i.e.)
(i.e.) c(t1 + t2) + a(t1t2)2 = 0
(i.e.)
From these equations, we note that t2, t3 are the roots of the
equation
476
This equation shows that BC touches the parabola y2 = 4ax. Since ABC is an
arbitrary triangle inscribed in the rectangular hyperbola xy = c2 there are
infinite number of such triangles touching the parabola y2 = 4ax.
Exercises
1. Prove that the portion of the tangent intercepted between by its asymptotes is
bisected at the point of contact and form a triangle of contact area.
2. If the tangent and normal to a rectangular hyperbola make
intercepts a1 and a2 on one asymptote and b1 and b2 on the other then show
that a1a2 + b1b2 = 0.
3. P and Q are variable points on the rectangular hyperbola xy = c2 such that the
tangent at Qpasses through the foot of the ordinate of P. Show that the locus of
the intersection of the tangents at P and Q is a hyperbola with the same
asymptotes as the given hyperbola.
4. If the lines x = 0 and y = 0 are conjugate lines with respect to the
hyperbola xy = c2 then prove that the point (, ) is on the hyperbola xy 2c2 =
0.
5. If the chords of the hyperbola x2 y2 = a2 touch the parabola y2 = 4ax then
prove that the locus of their middle points is the curve y2 (x a) = x3.
6. If PQ and PR are two perpendicular chords of the rectangular
hyperbola xy = c2 then show thatQR is parallel to the normal at P.
7. If the polar of a point with respect to the parabola y2 = 4ax touches the
parabola x2 = 4by, show that the point should lie on a rectangular hyperbola.
8. Show that the normal at the rectangular hyperbola xy = c2 at the
point
meets the curve again at the point
2
as CP where C is the centre.
477
478
these points is
30. If four points on a rectangular hyperbola xy = c2 lie on a circle, then prove that
the product of their abscissae is c4.
31. If x1, x2, x3 and x4 be the abscissae of the angular points and the orthocentre of a
triangle inscribed in xy = c2 then prove that x1x2x3x4 = c4.
32. Show that the length of the chord of the rectangular hyperbola xy = c2 which is
bisected at the point (h, k) is
33. Prove that the point of intersection of the asymptotes of a rectangular
hyperbola with the tangent at any point P and of the axes with the normal
at P are equidistant from P.
34. If P is any point on a rectangular hyperbola whose vertices are A and A' then
prove that the bisectors of angle APA' are parallel to the asymptotes of the
curve.
479
35. Let QCQ' is a diameter of a rectangular hyperbola and P is any point on the
curve. Prove thatPQ, PQ' are equally inclined to the asymptotes of the
hyperbola.
36. Through the point P(0, b) a line is drawn cutting the same branch of the
rectangular hyperbolaxy = c2 in Q and R such that PQ = QR. Show that its
equation is 9c2 y + 2b2 x = 9bc2.
37. If a rectangular hyperbola xy = c2 is cut by a circle passing through its
centre O in points A, B, Cand D whose parameters are t1, t2, t3 and t4 then show
that (t1 + t2)(t3 + t4) + t1t2 + t3t4 = 0 and deduce that the product of the
perpendicular from O on AB and CD is c2.
480
Chapter 9
Polar Coordinates
9.1 INTRODUCTION
We choose a point in the plane and it is called the pole (or origin) and is
denoted by O. Then we draw a ray (half line) starting at O called polar axis.
This is usually drawn horizontally to the right and corresponds to
positive x-axis in Cartesian coordinates.
Let P be any point in the plane and r be the distance from O to P. Let be
the angle (usually measured in radians) between the polar axis and the
line OP. Then the point P is represented by the ordered pair (r, ) and (r, )
are called the polar coordinates of the point P. We use the convention that
an angle is positive if measured in the anti-clockwise direction from the
polar axis and negative in the clockwise direction.
If P coincides with O then r = . Then (r, ) represent the coordinates of the
pole for any value of . Let us now extend the meaning of polar coordinates
(r, ) when r is negative, agreeing that the points (r, ) and (r, ) lie on the
same line through O and at the same distance |r| from O but on opposite
sides of O. If r > 0, the point (r, ) lies on the same quadrant as . If r < 0,
then it lies in the quadrant of the opposite side of the pole. We note that the
point (r, ) represents the same point as (r, + )
481
Example 9.2.1
Represent the following polar coordinates in the polar plane:
Solution
The coordinates,
in the following diagram:
and
is also represented
, etc.
482
If (x, y) is the Cartesian coordinates and (r,) are the polar coordinates of
the point P, then
and
We have already studied the distance between two points, area of a triangle,
equations of a straight line, equations to a circle and equation of conics in
Cartesian coordinates system. Let us now derive the results in polar
coordinate system.
9.4 POLAR EQUATION OF A STRAIGHT LINE
483
Let the origin be the pole and the x-axis be the initial line.
Draw ON perpendicular to the straight line. Let ON = p and XON = .
or
, where k is a constant.
, where k is a constant.
484
or
. In this
Example 9.5.6
Find the equation of the straight line joining the two points P(r1, 1)
and Q(r2, 2).
Solution
Let R(r, ) be any point on the line joining the points P and Q.
The area of the triangle formed by the points P(r1, 1), Q(r2, 2) and (r3, 3) is
485
and
Solution
The equations of the straight lines are
486
Example 9.5.9
Find the equation of the line joining the points
and
and deduce
Solution
The equation of the line joining the points (r1, 1) and (r2, 2) is
and
is
487
Example 9.5.10
Show that the straight lines r(cos + sin ) = 1 and r(cos sin ) = 1
enclose a square and calculate the length of the sides of this square.
Solution
Converting into Cartesian form the four lines are
488
and
Solution
Exercises
1. Find the angle between the lines
1. r cos = p, r sin = p1
2.
Ans.:
and
are collinear.
through
the pole is
4. Find the equation of the line perpendicular to
through the point (r1, 1).
Ans.:
and passing
489
9.6 CIRCLE
490
Note 9.6.1.3: If the pole lies on the circumference of the circle and the
initial line passes through the centre of the circle then the equation of the
circle becomes, r = 2a cos since = 0.
Note 9.6.1.4: Suppose the initial line is a tangent to the circle. Then c =
a cosec . Therefore, from equation (9.4) the equation of the circle
becomes, a2 = a2 cosec2 + r2 2ar cosec cos ( )
Note 9.6.1.5: Suppose the initial line is a tangent and the pole is at the
point of contact. In this case = 90. The equation of the circle
becomes, r2 2ra sin = 0 (or) r = 2a sin .
9.6.2 Equation of the Chord of the Circle r = 2a cos on the Line Joining the
Points (r1, 1) and (r2, 2).
Let PQ be the chord of the circle r = 2a cos .
491
492
9.6.4 Equation of the Circle on the Line Joining the Points (a, ) and (b, ) as the
ends of a Diameter
493
Since APB = 90
Example 9.6.1
Show that the locus of the foot of the perpendicular drawn from the pole to
the tangent to the circle r= 2a cos is r = a(l + cos ).
Solution
Let P be the point (r, ).
Draw ON perpendicular to the tangent at P.
r cos( 2) = 2a cos2
Since ON is the perpendicular distance from O on the line PN, from the
normal form of the straight line, we get
ON = p = 2a cos2
494
Example 9.6.2
Show that the feet of the perpendiculars from the origin on the sides of the
triangle formed by the points with vectorial angles , , and which lie on
the circle r = 2a cos lie on the straight line 2acos cos cos = r cos (
).
Solution
The equation of the circle is r = 2a cos .
Let the vectorial angles of P, Q, R be , , respectively.
The equations of the chord PQ, QR and RP are
Let L, M and N be the feet of the perpendiculars from O on the lines PQ,
QR and RP
Then from the above equations, we infer that the coordinates of L,
M and N are
495
Solution
The equation of the circle is
If the line (9.9) is a tangent to (9.8) then the two values of tan of the
equation (9.10) are equal. The condition for that is the discriminant is equal
to zero.
496
Exercises
1. Show that r = A cos + B sin represents a circle and find the polar
coordinates of the centre.
2. Show that the equation of the circle of radius a which touches the lines =
0,
is r2 2ar(cos + sin ) + a2 = 0. Show that locus of the equation r2
2ra cos2 sec 2a2 = 0 consists of a straight line and a circle.
3. Find the polar equations of circles passing through the points whose polar
coordinates are
4. A circle passes through the point (r, ) and touches the initial line at a
distance c from the pole. Show that its polar equation
is
5. Show that r2 kr cos( ) + kd = 0 represents a system of general circles for
different values ofk. Find the coordinates of the limiting points and the
equation of the common radical axis.
6. Find the equation of the circle whole centre is
and radius is 2.
Ans.:
7. Find the centre and radius of the circle r2 10r cos + 9 = 0.
Ans.: (5,0); 4
8. Prove that the equation to the circle described on the line joining the
points
and
as diameter is
1. tangent
2. a normal to the circle r = 2 cos .
may be a
10. Find the equation of the circle which touches the initial line, the vectorial angle
of the centre being and the radius of the circle a.
11. A circle passes through the point (r1, 1) and touches the initial line at a
distance c from the pole. Show that its polar equation is
497
is
an ellipse if e < 1.
2. a parabola if e = 1.
3. a hyperbola if e > 1.
Let LSL be the double ordinate through the focus (latus rectum).
The focus directrix property is
498
499
from 2 to 0.
and
varies from to
The conic in this case is a parabola and is shown below.
to l.
> 0. (i.e.)
Hence, as varies from to , r increases from 1 to . As varies
from to , 1 + e cos remains negative and varies from 0 to (1 e).
r varies from to to
500
is
The polar equation of the conic for different form of directrix is given
below.
501
Then
But
502
.
.
503
Subtracting, we get
9.7.6 Equation of Normal at the Point whose Vectorial Angle is on the Conic
504
is
we have
505
Substituting
asymptotes as
and
506
Let QR be the chord of contact of tangents from P(r1, 1). Let vectorial
angles of Q and R be and + . The equation of the chord QR is
507
Now the locus of the point T(R, ) is polar of the (r1, 1).
The polar of (r1, 1) from equation (9.28) is
508
Example 9.7.1
Find the condition that the straight line
may be a tangent to
the conic
Solution
Let the line
509
Solution
Let PQ be a focal chord of the conic
coordinates (SP, ) and (SQ, + ).
Since P and Q lie on the conic
We have
SP, l, SQ are in HP
510
we have
511
Example 9.7.4
If a chord PQ of a conic whose eccentricity e and the semi latus
rectum l subtends a right angle at the focus SP then prove
that
Solution
Let the equation of the conic be
of P be . The vectorial angle of Qis
512
Similarly,
Example 9.7.5
Let PSQ and PSR be two chords of an ellipse through the foci S and S.
Show that
is a constant.
Solution
Let the vectorial angle of P be . Then the vectorial angle of Q is + .
Since P and Q lie on the conic
513
, we get
Example 9.7.6
Prove that the perpendicular focal chords of a rectangular hyperbola are
equal.
Solution
Let PSP and QSQ and be two perpendicular focal chords of a rectangular
hyperbola. Then the vectorial angles of P and P are .
514
Since P lies on the other branch of the hyperbola, the polar equation of the
conic is
Similarly,
515
Example 9.7.7
The tangents to a conic at P and Q meet at T. Show that if S is a focus
then ST bisects PSQ.
Solution
Let the equation of the conic be
Example 9.7.8
If the tangents at the extremities of a focal chord through the focus S of the
conic
that
516
Solution
Let PSQ be a focal chord. Let the vectorial angles of P and Q be and + .
Then the equations of tangents at P and Q are
Example 9.7.9
If a chord of a conic
subtends an angle 2 at the focus then show
that the locus of the point where it meets the internal bisector of the angle
is
Solution
Let PQ be a chord of the conic
subtending an angle 2 at the
focus. Let the internal bisector of PSQ meets PQ at T. Let the vectorial
angles of P and Q be and + .
Let the polar coordinates of T be (r1, ).
517
is a constant.
Solution
Let the equation of the conic be
of P and Q be and + .
518
Example 9.7.11
519
If a focal chord of an ellipse makes an angle with the major axis then
show that the angle between the tangents at its extremities is
Solution
Let the equation of the conic be
520
Example 9.7.12
A focal chord SP of an ellipse is inclined at an angle to the major axis.
Prove that the perpendicular from the focus on the tangent at P makes with
the axis an angle
Solution
Let the equation of the conic be
521
Example 9.7.13
1.
If A circle passing through the focus of a conic whose latus rectum is 2l meets
the conic in four points whose distances from the focus are, r1, r2, r3, r4 then prove
that
2. A circle of given radius passing through the focus S of a given conic intersects
in A, b, C and D. Show that SA SB SC SD is a constant.
Solution
Let the equations of the conic be
Let a be the radius of the circle and be the angle the diameter makes with
the initial line.
Then the equation of the circle is
522
we get
If r1, r2, r3, r4 are the distances of the points of intersection from the focus
then
(i.e.) SA SB SC SD is a constant.
Example 9.7.14
523
524
Example 9.7.15
A variable chord of conic subtends a constant angle 2 at the focus of the
conic
Show that the chord touches another conic having the
same focus and directrix. Show also that the locus of poles of such chords of
the conic is also a similar conic.
Solution
Let PQ be a chord of the conic
the focus.
525
same focus and the same initial line as C. For the given conic
and
526
The locus of poles is the conic having the same focus and same directrix as
the given conic.
Example 9.7.16
Show that the locus of the point of intersection of tangents at the
extremities of a variable focal chord is the corresponding directrix.
Solution
Let the equation of the conic be
The equation of tangent at is
The equation of tangent at + is
527
Let P and Q be the points on the conic whose vectorial angles are and .
The equations of tangents at P and Q are
528
Substituting for
and
, we get
529
Example 9.7.19
If a normal is drawn at one extremity of the latus rectum, prove that the
distance from the focus of the other point in which it meets the conic
is
Solution
The equation of the conic is
530
is
If cos = 0 then
Example 9.7.20
If the tangents at the points P and Q on a conic intersect in T and the
chord PQ meets the directrix atR then prove that the angle TSR is a right
angle.
Solution
531
Let the vectorial angles of P and Q be and , respectively. Let the tangents
at P and Q meet at T(r1,1).
and
and
1 = (2 ) which implies
Let be the vectorial angle of R. The equation of
chord PQ is
The equation of the directrix
Example 9.7.21
532
and
533
Exercises
1. If PSP and QSQ are two focal chords of a conic cutting each other at right
angles then prove that
= a constant.
2. If two conics have a common focus then show that two of their common chords
pass through the point of intersection of their directrices.
3. Show that
and
represent the same conic.
4. In a parabola with focus S, the tangents at any points P and Q on it meet at T.
Prove that
1. SP SQ = ST2
2. The triangles SPT and SQT are similar.
5. If S be the focus, P and Q be two points on a conic such that the angle PSQ is
constant, prove that the locus of the point of intersection of the tangents
at P and Q is a conic section whose focus is S.
6. If the circle r + 2acos = 0 cuts the conic
in four real points
find the equation in rwhich determines the distances of these points from the
pole. Also, show that if their algebraic sum equals 2a and the eccentricity of the
conic is 2cos.
534
and
and the two conics touch at = . Prove that the length of its
latus rectum is
14. Prove that three normals can be drawn from a given point to a given parabola.
If the normal at, , on the conic
that
15. If the normals at three points of the parabola
whose vectorial
angles are , , meet in a point whose vectorial angle is then prove that
2 = + + .
16. If , , be the vectorial angles of three points on
, the normal at
535
21. If the tangent at any point of an ellipse make an angle a with its major axis and
an angle with the focal radius to the point of contact then show that e cos =
cos
22. Prove that the exterior angle between any two tangents to a parabola is equal to
half the difference of the vectorial angles of their points of contact.
23. Find the condition that the straight line
may be a tangent to
the conic
24. Find the locus of poles of chords which subtend a constant angle at the focus.
25. Prove that if the chords of a conic subtend a constant angle at the focus, the
tangents at the end of the chord will meet on a fixed conic and the chord will
touch another fixed conic.
26. Find the locus of the point of intersection of the tangents to the
conic
at P and Q, where
, k being a constant.
27. If the tangent and normal at any point P of a conic meet the transverse axis
of T and G, respectively, and if S be the focus then prove that
constant.
is a
536
Chapter 10
Tracing of Curves
10.1 GENERAL EQUATION OF THE SECOND DEGREE AND TRACING OF A CONIC
537
From (10.1) and (10.2) we see that X = x cos + y sin, Y = x sin + y cos.
10.4 REMOVAL OF XY-TERM
Here we want to transform the second degree equation ax2 + 2hxy + by2 +
22x + 2fy + c = 0 into a second degree curve without XY-term, where the
axes are rotated through an angle without changing the origin we get
538
Hence, by rotating the axes through an angle about O the general second
degree expression will result into a second degree expression without XYterms.
10.5 INVARIANTS
We will now prove that the expression ax2 + 2hxy + by2 will change to Ax2 +
2hXY + By2 if (i) a + b =A + B and (ii) ab h2 = AB H2.
Proof:
Let P(x, y) be any point with respect to axes (ox, oy) and (X, Y) be its
coordinates with respect to (OX, OY). Then x = X cos Y sin, y =
X sin + Y cos. Therefore, we get x2 + y2 = X2 + Y2
Suppose ax2 + 2hxy + by2 = AX2 + 2HXY + BY2. Then ax2 +
2hxy + by2 + (x2 + y2) = AX2 + 2HXY +BY2 + (X2 + Y2).
539
If the LHS is of the form (px + qy)2 then it will be changed into the form
[p(X cos Y sin) + q(Xsin + Y cos)]2 = (p1X + q1Y)2.
If the axes are rotated through an angle with the anticlockwise direction
then
Then the equation transformed with the second degree in (X, Y ) is
540
541
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
It will represent a pair of straight line if abc + 2fgh af2 bg2 ch2 = 0.
It will represent a circle if a = b and h = 0.
It will represent a parabola if ab h2 = 0.
It will represent an ellipse if ab h2 > 0.
It will represent a hyperbola if ab h2 < 0.
It will represent a rectangular hyperbola if a + b = 0.
10.7 CENTRE OF THE CONIC GIVEN BY THE GENERAL EQUATION OF THE SECOND
DEGREE
Since this equation has x and y terms, the centre is not at the origin. Let us
suppose the centre is at (x1, y1). Let us now shift the origin to (x1, y1) without
changing the direction of axes. Then X = x + x1,Y = y + y1. Then equation
(10.10) takes the form
Since the origin is shifted to the point (x1, y1) with respect to new axes, the
coefficient of X and Y in(10.11) should be zero.
542
From the result obtained in Section 10.7, the equation of the conic referred
to centre as the origin isax2 + 2hxy + by2 + C1 = 0, where,
Therefore, the coordinates of the centre of the conic are given by solving the
equations
and
Example 10.8.1
Find the nature of the conic and find its centre. Also write down the
equation of the conic referred to centre as origin:
1. 2x2 5xy 3y2 x 4y + 5 = 0
2. 5x2 6xy + 5y2 + 22x 26y + 29 = 0
Solution
1. Given: 2x2 5xy 3y2 x 4y + 5 = 0
543
Here,
Therefore, the conic is a hyperbola.
The coordinates of the centre are given by
The equation of
Solving these equations we get the centre as (1, 2). The equation of the
conic referred to centre as origin is 5x2 6xy + 5y2 + C1 = 0
where C1 = gx1 + fy1 + c.
C1 = 11 (1) 13(2) + 29 = 11 26 + 29 = 8
544
10.9 LENGTH AND POSITION OF THE AXES OF THE CENTRAL CONIC WHOSE
EQUATION IS AX2 + 2HXY + BY2 = 1
Given:
The equation of the circle concentric with this conic and radius r is
545
The eccentricity of the conic can be determined from the length of the axes.
10.10 AXIS AND VERTEX OF THE PARABOLA WHOSE EQUATION IS AX2 + 2HXY + BY2 +
2GX + 2FY + C = 0
and
546
Since the above equation represents a parabola, the axis of the parabola
is px + qy + = 0 and the tangent at the vertex
is
is
Example 10.10.1
Trace the conic 36x2 + 24xy + 29y2 72x + 126y + 81 = 0.
Solution
Given:
547
and
548
Referring to the centre the equation of major and minor axes are
and
and (6, 0).
ab h2 = 1 1 4 = 3 < 0.
Therefore, the conic is a hyperbola. The coordinates of the centre are given
by
549
(i.e.) 2x + 4y 2 = 0 or x + 2y 1 = 0
550
(i.e.) x + y =0
The points where the hyperbola meets the x-axis are given by x2 2x 6 =
0.
551
Example 10.10.3
Trace the conic x2 + 2xy + y2 2x 1 = 0.
Solution
a = 1, b = 1, h = 1, g = 1, f = 0, c = 1
552
or 2x + 2y 1 = 0
x2 2x 1 = 0 x = 2.4, 0.4
Therefore, the points on the curve are (0.4, 0) and (2.4, 0).
When the curve meets the y-axis, x = 0.
y2 = 1 or y = 1
553
Exercises
Trace the following conics:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
554
Chapter 11
Three Dimension
11.1 RECTANGULAR COORDINATE AXES
To locate a point in a plane, two numbers are necessary. We know that any
point in the xy plane can be represented as an ordered pair (a, b) of real
numbers where a is called x-coordinate of the point and b is called the ycoordinate of the point. For this reason, a plane is called two dimensional.
To locate a point in space, three numbers are required. Any point in space is
represented by an ordered triple (a, b, c) of real numbers. To represent a
point in space we first choose a fixed point O (called the origin) and then
three directed lines through O which are perpendicular to each other (called
coordinate axes) and labelled x-axis, y-axis as being horizontal and z-axis as
vertical and we take the orientation of the axes. In order to do this, we first
choose a fixed point O. In looking at the figure, you can think of y- and zaxes as lying in the plane of the paper and x-axis as coming out of the paper
towards y-axis. The direction of z-axis is determined by the neighbourhood
rule. If you curl the fingers of your right-hand around the z-axis in the
direction of a 90 counter clockwise rotation from the positive x-axis to the
positive y-axis then your thumb points in the positive direction of thez-axis.
The three coordinate axes are determined by the three coordinate planes.
The xy-plane is the plane that contains x and y-axes, the yz-plane
contains y and z-axes and the xz-plane contains x- and z-axes.
555
These three coordinate planes divide the space into eight parts called
octants. The first octant is determined by the positive axes. Look at any
bottom corner of a room and call the corner as origin.
The wall on your left is in the xz-plane. The wall on your right is in the yzplane. The wall on the floor is in the xy-plane. The x-axis runs along the
intersection of the floor and the left wall. The y-axis runs along the
intersection of the floor and the right wall. The z-axis runs up from the floor
towards the ceiling along the intersection of the two walls are situated in
the first octant and you can now imagine seven other rooms situated in the
other seven octants (three on the same floor and fourth on the floor below),
all are connected by the common point O.
If P is any point in space, and a be the directed distance in the first octant
from the yz-plane to P. Let the directed distance from the xz-plane be b and
let c be the distance from xy-plane to P.
556
We represent the point P by the ordered triple (a, b, c) of real numbers and
we call a, b and c the coordinates of P. a is the x-coordinate, b is the ycoordinate and c is the z-coordinate. Thus, to locate the point (a, b, c) we
can start at the origin O and move a units along x-axis then b units parallel
toy-axis and c units parallel to the z-axis as shown in the above figure.
557
Consider a rectangular box, where P and Q are the opposite corners and the
faces of the box are parallel to the coordinate planes. If A(x1, y1, z1)
and B(x2, y2, z2) are the vertices of the box indicated in the above figure,
then
Since the triangles PBQ and PAB are both right angled, by Pythagoras
theorem,
Example 11.2.1
Find the distance between the points (2, 1, 5) and (4, 7, 6).
Solution
558
units
Aliter:
Let P(x1, y1, z1) and (x2, y2, z2) be two points. Draw PA, QB perpendicular
to xy-plane. Then the coordinates of A and B are (x1, y1, 0) and (x2, y2, 0).
Example 11.2.2
559
However,
560
Let ABC be a triangle with vertices A(x1, y1, z1), B(x2, y2, z2) and C(x3, y3, z3).
Then the midpoint of BCis D
561
Let G be the centroid of the triangle ABC. Then G divides AD in the ratio
2:1. Then the Coordinates ofG are
The centroid of the tetrahedron divides AD in the ratio 3:1. Therefore, the
coordinates of G are
562
the direction cosines of the line. The directional cosines are denoted
by l, m and n.
Also,
Similarly, x = r cos and z = r cos.
563
l2 + m2 + n2 = 1
564
565
In addition,
ratios of PQ are
Since OP and OQ are parallel to the two given lines then the angle between
the two given lines is equal to the angle between the lines OP and OQ.
Since OP = OQ = 1 unit, the coordinates of P and Qare (l1, m1, n1) and
(l2, m2, n2). Let
Then PQ2 = OP2 + OQ2 2OP OQ cos = 1 + 1 211 cos
Also,
566
Note 11.5.4.1: If the two lines are perpendicular then = 90 and cos90
= 0.
Note11.5.4.3:
Note 11.5.4.4: If a1, b1, c1 and a2, b2, c2 are the direction ratios of the two
lines then
567
Also, if a1, b1, c1 and a2, b2, c2 are the direction ratios of two parallel lines
then
ILLUSTRATIVE EXAMPLES
Example 11.1
Show that the points (2, 5, 8), (6, 7, 4) and (3, 4, 4) form a right-angled
triangle.
Solution
The given points are A(2, 5, 8), B(6, 7, 4) and C(3, 4, 4).
Since BC2 + AC2 = AB2, the triangle is right angled. Since BC = AC, the
triangle is also isosceles.
Example 11.2
568
Show that the points (3, 2, 5), (2, 1, 3), (1, 2, 1) and (0, 3, 3) taken in order
form a parallelogram.
Solution
Let the four points be A(3, 2, 5), B(2, 1, 3), C(1, 2, 1) and D(0, 3, 3).
Then,
569
Show that the points (3, 2, 2), (1, 1, 3), (0, 5, 6) and (2, 1, 2) lie on a sphere
whose centre is (1, 3, 4). Also find its radius.
Solution
Let the given points be S(2, 1, 2), P(3, 2, 2), Q(1, 1, 3), R(0, 5, 6) and C(1, 3,
4).
(i.e.) The ratio in which PQ divides the plane YZ-plane is 1:7 externally.
Similarly,
570
Also
externally.
or
Example 11.6
P and Q are the points (3, 4, 12) and (1, 2, 2). Find the coordinates of the
points in which the bisector of the angle POQ meets PQ.
Solution
We know that
R divides PQ internally in the ratio 13:3 and S divides PQ externally in the
ratio 13:3.
Therefore, the coordinates of R are
(i.e.)
571
Example 11.7
Prove that the three lines which join the midpoints of opposite edges of a
tetrahedron pass through the same point and are bisected at that point.
Solution
Let ABCD be a tetrahedron with vertices (xi, yi, zi), i = 1, 2, 3, 4. The three
pairs of opposite edges are (AD, BC), (BD, AC) and (CD, AB). Let (L, N),
(P, Q) and (R, S) be the midpoints of the three pairs of opposite edges.
Then L is the point
M is the point
The midpoint of LM is
By symmetry, this is also the midpoint of the lines PQ and RS.
Therefore, the lines LM, PQ and RS are concerned and are bisected at that
point.
Example 11.8
A plane triangle of sides a, b and c is placed so that the midpoints of the
sides are on the axes. Show that the lengths l, m and n intercepted on the
axes are given by 8l2 = b2 + c2 a2, 8m2 = c2 + a2 b2and
8n2 = a2 + b2 c2 and that the coordinates of the vertices of the triangle are
(l, m, n), (l, m, n) and (l, m, n).
Solution
572
Similarly,
Therefore, the vertices are (l, m, n), (l,m, n) and (l, m, n).
573
Example 11.9
A directed line makes angles 60 and 60 with x- and y-axes, respectively.
Find the angle it makes with z-axis.
Solution
If a line makes angles , and with x-, y- and z-axes, respectively then
cos2 + cos2 + cos2 = 1.
Here, = 60, = 60
Example 11.10
Find the acute angle between the lines whose direction ratios are 2, 1, 2
and 1, 1, 0.
574
Solution
The direction cosines of the two lines are
Example 11.11
Find the angle between any two diagonals of a unit cube.
Solution
The four diagonals of the cube are OO, AA, BB and CC. Then the
direction ratios of
OO and AA are (1, 1, 1) and (1, 1, 1). The direction cosines of OO and AA
are
diagonals then
and
575
576
But
perpendicular
Therefore, the direction cosines of the line perpendicular to the given two
lines are m1n2 m2n1, n1l2 n2l1, l1m2 l2m1.
Example 11.14
Show that three concurrent straight lines with direction
cosines l1,m1,n1; l2,m2,n2 and l3,m3,n3 are coplanar if
Solution
Let l, m and n be the direction cosines of the line which is perpendicular to
the given three lines. If the lines are coplanar then the line with direction
cosines l, m and n is normal to the given coplanar line.
577
Prove that the straight lines whose direction cosines are given by the
equations al + bm + cn = 0 andfmn + gnl + hlm = 0 are perpendicular
if
Solution
The direction cosines of two lines are given by
From (11.5),
Substituting in (11.6), we get
If l1,m1,n1 and l2,m2,n2 are the direction cosines of the two given lines
then
and
Similarly,
But l1l2 + m1m2 + n1n2 = 0
Dividing
Example 11.16
578
If two pair of opposite edges of a tetrahedron are at right angles then show
that the third pair is also at right angles.
Solution
Let (OA, BC), (OB, CA) and (OC, AB) be three pair of opposite edges.
Let O be the origin. Let the coordinates of A, B and C be (x1, y1, z1), (x2, y2, z2)
and (x3, y3, z3), respectively. Then the direction ratios
of OA and BC are x1, y1, z1 and x2 x3, y2 y3, z2 z3.
Since OA is perpendicular to BC, we get
also
579
Let be the angle between the lines with the direction cosines l1,m1,n1 and
direction ratios l1 + l2 +l3,m1 + m2 + m3 and n1 + n2 + n3. Then,
Similarly, the other two angles are equal to the same value of .
Therefore, the lines with the direction
ratios l1 + l2 + l3,m1 + m2 + m3,n1 + n2 + n3 are equally inclined to the line with
direction cosines l1,m1,n1; l2,m2,n2 and l3,m3,n3.
Example 11.18
Show that the straight lines whose direction cosines are given
by a2l + b2m + c2n = 0, mn + nl + lm = 0 will be parallel if a b c = 0.
Solution
Given the direction cosines of two given lines satisfy the equations
From (11.11),
Substituting this value of n in (11.12), we get
580
Dividing by
If l1,m1,n1 and l2,m2,n2 are the direction cosines of the two given lines
then
Example 11.19
The projections of a line on the axes are 3, 4, 12. Find the length and
direction cosines of the line.
Solution
Let (l, m, n) be the direction cosines of the line and (x1, y1, z1) and (x2, y2, z2)
be the extremities of the line. The direction cosines of x-, y and z-axes are
(1, 0, 0), (0, 1, 0) and (0, 0, 1), respectively. The projection of the line on the
axis is 3.
x2 x1 = 3.
Similarly, y2 y1 = 4, z2 z1 = 12
581
Ans.: (5, 4)
11. The line joining the points A(2, 6, 4) and B(1, 3, 7) meets the YOZ-plane at C.
Find the coordinates of C.
Ans.: (0, 4, 6)
12. Three vertices of a parallelogram ABCD are A(3, 4, 7), B(5, 3, 2) and C(1, 2,
3). Find the coordinates of D.
Ans.: (9, 5, 6)
582
13. Show that the points (5, 6, 8), (1, 8, 11), (4, 2, 9) and (2, 0, 6) are the vertices
of a square.
14. Show that the points P(3, 2, 4), Q(9, 8, 10) and R(5, 4, 6) are collinear.
Find the ratio in which R divides PQ.
Ans.: (1, 2)
15. Find the ratio in which the coordinate planes divide the line joining the points
(2, 4, 7) and (3, 5, 8).
16. Prove that the line drawn from the vertices of a tetrahedron to the centroids of
the opposite faces meet in a point which divides them in the ratio 3:1.
17. Find the coordinate of the circumcentre of the triangle formed by the points
with vertices (1, 2, 1), (2, 2, 1) and (1, 1, 0).
Ans.:
18. A and B are the points (2, 3, 5) and (7, 2, 4). Find the coordinates of the points
which the bisectors of the angles AOB meet AB.
19. Find the length of the median through A of the triangle A(2, 1, 4), B(3, 7, 6)
and C(5, 0, 2).
Ans.: 7
20. Prove that the locus of a point, the sum of whose distances from the points (a,
0, 0) and (a, 0, 0) is a constant 2k, is the curve
21. What are the direction cosines of the line which is equally inclined to the axes?
Ans.:
22. Find the angle between the lines whose direction ratios are (2, 3, 4) and (1, 2,
1).
Ans.:
23. A variable line in two adjacent positions has direction cosines (l, m, n),
(l + l,m + m,n + n). Prove that the small angle between two positives is
given by 2 = (l)2 + (m)2 + (n)2.
583
24. Find the angle between the lines AB and CD, where A, B, C and D are the points
(3, 4, 5), (4, 6, 3), (1, 2, 4) and (1, 0, 5), respectively.
Ans.:
25. Prove by direction cosines the points (1, 2, 3), (2, 3, 4) and (0, 7, 10) are
collinear.
26. Find the angle between the lines whose direction ratios are (2, 1, 2) and (1, 1,
0).
Ans.:
27. Show that the line joining the points (1, 2, 3) and (1, 5, 7) is parallel to the line
joining the points (4, 3, 6) and (2, 9, 2).
28. P, Q, R and S are the points (2, 3, 1), (3, 5, 3), (1, 2, 3) and (2, 5, 7). Show
that PQ is perpendicular to RS.
29. Prove that the three lines with direction ratios (1, 1, 1), (1, 3, 0) and (1, 0, 3)
lie in a plane.
30. Show that the lines whose direction cosines are given by al + bm + cn = 0
and al2 + bm2 + cn2 = 0 are parallel if
31. Show that the lines whose direction cosines are given by the
equations al + vm + wn = 0 and al2+ bm2 + cn2 = 0 are parallel if u2(b + c)
+ v2(c + a) + w2(a + b) = 0 and perpendicular if
32. If the edges of a rectangular parallelepiped are a, b and c, show that the angle
between the four diagonals are given by cos-1
33. If in a tetrahedron the sum of the squares of opposite edges is equal, show that
its pairs of opposite sides are at right angles.
34. Find the angle between the lines whose direction cosines are given by the
equations:
1. l + m + n = 0 and l2 + m2 n2 = 0
2. l + m + n = 0 and 2lm 2nl mn = 0
Ans.: (i)
(ii)
584
35. If (l1,m1,n1) and (l2,m2,n2) are the direction cosines of two lines inclined at an
angle q, show that the actual direction cosines of the direction between the
lines are
36. AB, BC are the diagonals of adjacent faces of a rectangular box with centre at
the origin O its edges being parallel to axes. If the
angles AOB, BOC and COA are , and , respectively then prove that cos +
cos + cos = 1.
37. If the projections of a line on the axes are 2, 3, 6 then find the length of the line.
Ans.: 7
38. The distance between the points P and Q and the lengths of the projections
of PQ on the coordinate planes are d1,d2 and d3, show that
39. Show that the three lines through the origin with direction ratios (1, 1, 7), (1,
1, 0) and (1, 0, 3) lie on a plane.
40. Show that the angle between the lines whose direction cosines are given
by l + m + n = 0 andfmn + gnl + hlm = 0 is
585
Chapter 12
Plane
12.1 INTRODUCTION
where a, b, c and d are constants. Let P(x1, y1, z1) and Q(x2, y2, z2) be two
points on the locus ofequation (12.1). Then the coordinates of the points
that divide line joining these two points in the ratio :1
are
(12.1) then
Since P(x1, y1, z1) and Q(x2, y2, z2) are two points on the locus of the equation
(12.1) these two points have to satisfy the locus of the equation (12.1).
586
Multiplying (12.4) by and adding with (12.3), we get (ax1 + by1 + cz1 + d)
+ (ax2 + by2 + cz2 + d) = 0 which is the equation (12.2).
Hence, this shows that if two points lies on the locus of equation (12.1) then
every point on this line is also a point on the locus of equation (12.1).
Hence, the equation (12.1) represents a plane and thus we have shown that
every first degree equation in x, y and z represents a plane.
12.3 GENERAL EQUATION OF A PLANE PASSING THROUGH A GIVEN POINT
Let the equation of the plane passing through a given point (x1, y1, z1) be
Subtracting (12.6) from (12.5), we get a(x x1) + b(y y1) + c(z z1) = 0.
This is the general equation of the plane passing through the given point
(x1, y1, z1).
12.4 EQUATION OF A PLANE IN INTERCEPT FORM
587
Let this plane make intercepts a, b and c on the axes of coordinates. If this
plane meets the x-, y- andz-axes at A, B and C then their coordinates are (a,
0, 0), (0, b, 0) and (0, 0, c), respectively. Since these points lie on the
plane Ax + By + Cz + D = 0, the coordinates of the points have to satisfy the
equation Ax + By + Cz + D = 0.
588
Therefore, the locus of (x1, y1, z1) is xcos + ycos + zcos = p. This equation
is called the normal form of a plane.
Note 12.5.1: Here, the coefficients of x, y and z are the direction cosines of
normal to the plane andp is the perpendicular distance from the origin on
the plane.
Note 12.5.2: Reduction of a plane to normal form: the equation of plane in
general form is
589
are
590
The angle between two planes is defined to be the angle between the
normals to the two planes. Let be the angle between the planes.
Note 12.6.1: The positive sign of cos gives the acute angle between the
planes and negative sign gives the obtuse angle between the planes.
Note 12.6.2: If the planes are perpendicular then = 90.
and P( x1, y1, z1) be the given point. We have to find the perpendicular
distance from P to the plane. The normal form of the plane (12.12) is
591
where p1 is the perpendicular distance from the origin to the plane (12.13).
This plane passes through (x1, y1, z1).
592
Let (x1, y1, z1), (x2, y2, z2) and (x3, y3, z3) be three given points on a plane.
Let the equation of the plane be
593
This plane also passes through (x2, y2, z2) and (x3, y3, z3).
get
This is the equation of the required plane.
Aliter:
Let the equation of the plane be
This plane passes through the points (x1, y1, z1), (x2, y2, z2) and (x3, y3, z3).
get
This is the equation of the required plane.
594
Let the line joining the points P(x1, y1, z1) and Q(x2, y2, z2) meet the plane
at R. Let R divided PQ in the ratio :1. Then the coordinates
of R are
Note 12.8.1: If (ax1 + by1 + cz1 + d) and (ax2 + by2 + cz2 + d) are of the same
sign then is negative. Then the point R divides PQ externally and so the
points P and Q lie on the same side of the plane.
Note 12.8.2: If P(x1, y1, z1) and the origin lie on the same side of the
plane ax + by + cz + d = 0 if ax1+ by1 + cz1 + d and d of the same sign.
12.10 PLANE PASSING THROUGH THE INTERSECTION OF TWO GIVEN PLANES
595
Then consider the equation (ax1 + by1 + cz1 + d1) + (ax2 + by2 + cz2 + d2) =
0. This being the first degree equation in x, y and z, represents a plane. Let
(x1, y1, z1) be the point on the line of the intersection of planes given
by equations (12.24) and (12.25). Then (x1, y1, z1) lies on the two given
planes.
Then, clearly (a1x1 + b1y1 + c1z1 + d1) + (a2x1 + b2y1 + c2z2 + d2) = 0.
From this equation, we infer that the point (x1, y1, z1) lies on the plane given
by (12.26). Similarly, every point in the line of intersection of the
planes (12.24) and (12.25) lie on the planes (12.24) and(12.25).
Hence, equation (12.26) is the plane passing through the intersection of the
two given planes.
12.11 EQUATION OF THE PLANES WHICH BISECT THE ANGLE BETWEEN TWO GIVEN
PLANES
Find the equation of the planes which bisect the angle between
two given planes.
Let the two given planes be
Let P(x1, y1, z1) be a point on either of the bisectors of the angle between the
two given planes. Then the perpendicular distance from P to the two given
planes are equal in magnitude.
596
By taking the positive sign, we get the equation of one of the bisectors and
by taking the negative sign, we get the equation to the other bisector.
Note 12.11.1: We can determine which of the two planes bisects the acute
angle between the planes. For this, we have to find the angle between the
bisector planes and one of the two given planes. If tan < 1 ( < 45), then
the bisector plane taken is the internal bisector and the other bisector plane
is the external bisector. If tan > 1 then the bisector plane taken is the
external bisector and the other bisector plane is the internal bisector.
Note 12.11.2: We can also determine the equation of the plane bisecting
the angle between the planes that contain the origin. Suppose the equation
of the two planes are a1x + b1y + c1z + d1 = 0 anda2x + b2y + c2z + d2 = 0
where d1 and d2 are positive. Let P(x1, y1, z1) be a point on the bisector
between the angles of the planes containing the origin.
Then d1 and a1x + b1y + c1z + d are of the sign. Since d1 is
positive, a1x + b1y + c1z is also positive. Similarly, a2x + b2y + c2z + d2 is also
positive. Therefore, the equation of the plane bisecting the angle containing
the origin is
The equation of bisector plane not containing the origin
is
12.12 CONDITION FOR THE HOMOGENOUS EQUATION OF THE SECOND DEGREE TO
REPRESENT A PAIR OF PLANES
The equation that represents a pair of planes be ax2 + by2 + cz2 + 2fyz +
2gzx + 2hxy = 0.
Let the two planes represented by the above homogenous equation of the
second degree in x, y and zbe lx + my + nz = 0 and l1x + m1y + n1z = 0.
597
Then
598
Example 12.1
The foot of the perpendicular from the origin to a plane is (13, 4, 3). Find
the equation of the plane.
Solution
The line joining the points (0, 0, 0) and (13, 4, 3) is normal to the plane.
Therefore, the direction ratios of the normal to the plane are (13, 4, 3).
The equation of the plane is a(x x1) + b(y y1) + c(z z1)= 0
Example 12.2
A plane meets the coordinate axes at A, B and C such that the centroid of
the triangle is the point (a,b, c). Find the equation of the plane.
599
Solution
Let the equation of the plane be
Then the coordinates
of A, B and C are (, 0, 0), (0, , 0) and (0, 0, ). The centroid of the
triangle ABC is
0a + b + c = 0 and 3a + b + c = 0
Solving we get
Therefore, the equation of the plane is 1(x 2) + 3(y 2) 3(z 1) = 0.
x + 3y 3z 5 = 0
Example 12.4
Find the equation of the plane passing through the point (2, 3, 4) and
parallel to the plane 2x 5y 7z + 15 = 0.
600
Solution
The equation of the plane parallel to 2x 5y 7z + 15 = 0 is 2x 5y
7z + k = 0. This plane passes through the point (2, 3, 4).
4 + 15 28 + k = 0 or k = 9
Therefore, the direction ratios of the normal to the required plane are 1, 3,
1.
Therefore, the equation of the plane is (x 2) + 0 + (z 4) = 0 (i.e.) (x 2)
+ 3(y 2) (z 4) = 0.
x + 3y z 4 = 0
Example 12.6
601
602
The equation of the same plane with respect to the second system of
coordinate axes is
603
Example 12.9
A variable plane passes through a fixed point (a, b, c) and meets the
coordinate axes in A, B and C. Prove that the locus of the point of
intersection of planes through A, B and C parallel to the coordinate planes
is
Solution
Let the equation of the plane be
This plane passes through the point (a, b, c).
604
is
Example 12.10
A variable plane makes intercepts on the coordinate axes, the sum of whose
squares is constant and is equal to k2. Prove that the locus of the foot of the
perpendicular from the origin to the plane is (x2 +y2 + z2) (x2 + y2 + z2)
= k2.
Solution
Let the equation of the plane be
where a, b and c are the intercepts on the coordinate axes. Given that
Let P(x1, y1, z1) be the foot of the perpendicular from O on this plane. The
direction ratios of the normal OP are
Therefore, the equation of the
normal OP are ax = by = cz. Since (x1, y1, z1) lies on the
normal, ax1 = by1 + cz1 = t (say).
605
B and C are (a, 0, 0), (0, b, 0), (0, 0, c). The centroid of ABC is
But the centroid is given as (1, 2, 4).
a = 3, b = 6, c = 12
(i.e.) 4x + 2y + z + 12 = 0
Example 12.12
606
Find the equation of the plane passing through the point (1, 3, 2) and
perpendicular to the planes x+ 2y + 2z = 5 and 3x + 3y + 2z = 8.
Solution
The equation of the plane passing through the point (1, 3, 2) is A(x + 1)
+ B(y 3) + C(z 2) = 0. This plane is perpendicular to the planes x + 2y +
2z = 5 and 3x + 3y + 2z = 8. If two planes are perpendicular then their
normals are perpendicular. The direction ratios of the normal to the
required plane are A, B and C. The direction ratios of the normals to the
given planes are 1, 2, 2 and 3, 3, 2.
Therefore, the direction ratios of the normal to the required plane are 2, 4,
3. The equation of the required plane is 2(x + 1) 4(y 3) + 3(z 2) = 0
(i.e.) 2x 4y + 3z + 8 = 0.
Example 12.13
Find the equation of the plane passing through the points (9, 3, 6) and (2, 2,
1) and perpendicular to the plane 2x + 6y + 6z 9 + 0.
Solution
Any plane passing through the point (9, 3, 6) is
607
3x + 4y 5z = 9
Example 12.14
Show that the following points (0, 1, 0), (2, 1, 1), (1, 1, 1) and (3, 3, 0) are
coplanar.
Solution
The equation of the plane passing through the point (0, 1, 0) is Ax + B(y +
1) + Cz = 0.
This plane passes through the points (2, 1, 1) and (1, 1, 1).
4x 3y + 2z 3 = 0.
608
Therefore, the plane passes through the points (3, 3, 0) and hence the four
given points are coplanar.
Example 12.15
Find for what values of , the points (0, 1, ), (4, 5, 1), (3, 9, 4) and (4, 4,
4) are coplanar.
Solution
The equation of the plane passing through the point (4, 5, 1) is A(x 4)
+ B(y 5) + C(z 1) = 0.
This plane passes through the points (3, 9, 4) and (4, 4, 4).
609
610
Example 12.18
If from the point P(a, b, c) perpendiculars PL, PM be drawn
to YZ- and ZX- planes, find the equation of the plane OLM.
Solution
P is the point (a, b, c).PL is drawn perpendicular to YZ-plane. Therefore,
the coordinates of L are (0,b, 0).PM is drawn perpendicular to ZX-plane.
Therefore, the coordinates of M are (0, 0, c). We have to find the equation
of the plane OLM. The equation of the plane passing through (0, 0, 0)
is Ax + By+ Cz = 0. This plane also passes through (0, b, c), (a, 0, c).
611
The equation of the plane through the point (1, 1, 0) is A(x 1) + b(y 1)
+ C(z 0) = 0.
This plane also passes through (1, 2, 1) and (2, 2, 1).
we get 1 + 6 0 5 = 0 which is
612
Therefore, the plane divides the line externally in the ratio 17:27.
Example 12.21
A plane triangle whose sides are of length a, b, and c is placed so that the
middle points of the sides are on the axes. If , and are intercepts on the
613
where
Solution
614
Let (x1, y1, z1),(x2, y2, z2) and (x3, y3, z3) be the vertices of the ABC.
Then
Similarly,
615
. If is the angle
Example 12.23
Prove that the plane x + 2y + 2z = 0, 2x + y 2z = 0 are at right angles.
Solution
The direction ratios of the normals to the planes are 1, 2, 2 and 2, 1, 2. If
the lines are to be perpendicular then a1a2 + b1b2 + c1c2 = 0.
Hence, a1a2 + b1b2 + c1c2 = 2 + 2 4 = 0.
Therefore, the normals are perpendicular and hence the planes are
perpendicular.
Example 12.24
Find the equation of the plane containing the line of intersection of the
planes x + y + z 6 = 0, 2x + 3y + 4z + 5 = 0 and passing through the point
(1, 1, 1).
Solution
The equation of any plane containing the line is x + y + z 6 = (2x + 3y +
4z + 5) = 0. If this line passes through the point (1, 1, 1) then, 1 + 1 + 1 6
+ (2 + 3 + 4 + 5) = 0.
616
Example 12.25
Find the equation of the plane which passes through the intersection of the
planes 2x + 3y + 10z 8 = 0, 2x 3y + 7z 2 = 0 and is perpendicular to
the plane 3x 2y + 4z 5 = 0.
Solution
The equation of any plane passing through the intersection of the planes
2x + 3y + 10z 8 = 0 and 2x 3y + 7z 2 = 0 is 2x + 3y + 10z 8 + (2x
3y + 7z 2) = 0.
The direction ratios of the normal to this plane are 2 + 2, 3 3, 10 + 7.
The direction ratios of the plane 3x 2y + 4z 5 = 0 are 3, 2, 4. Since
these two planes are perpendicular, 3(2 + 2) 2 (3 3) + 4(10 + 7) = 0.
Example 12.26
The plane x 2y + 3z = 0 is rotated through a right angle about its line of
intersection with the plane 2x + 3y 4z + 2 = 0. Find the equation of the
plane in its new position.
Solution
The plane x 2y + 3z = 0 is rotated about the line of intersection of the
planes
617
The new position of the plane (12.58) passes through the line of intersection
of the two given planes. Therefore, its equation is
Example 12.27
The line lx + my = 0 is rotated about its line of intersection with the
plane z = 0 through an angle . Prove that the equation of the plane
is
Solution
Any plane passing through the intersection of lx + my = 0 and z = 0 is
618
Example 12.28
Find the equation of the plane passing through the line of intersection of
the planes 2x y + 5z 3 = 0 and 4x + 2y z + 7 = 0 and parallel to z-axis.
Solution
The equation of the plane passing through the line of intersection of the
given planes is 2x y + 5z 3 + (4x + 2y z + 7) = 0. If the plane is
parallel to z-axis, its normal is perpendicular to z-axis. The directions of the
normal to the plane are 2 + 4, 1 + 2, 5 . The direction ratios of the zaxis are 0, 0, 1.
Example 12.29
Find the distance of the points (2, 3, 5), (3, 4, 7) from the plane x + 2y
2z = 9 and prove that these points lie on the opposite sides of the plane.
Solution
619
Let the line joining the points P(2, 3, 5) and Q(3, 4, 7) be divided by the
plane in the ratio :1.
Therefore, the points P and Q lie on the opposite side of the plane. The
perpendicular distance from (2, 3, 5) to the plane x + 2y 2z 9 = 0
is
The perpendicular distance from (3, 4, 7) to the plane
is
Note 12.29.1: Since p1 and p2 are of opposite signs the points are on the
opposite sides of the plane.
Example 12.30
Prove that the points (2, 3, 5) and (3, 4, 7) lie on the opposite sides of the
plane which meets the axes in A, B and C such that the centroid of the
triangle A, B and C is the points (1, 2, 4).
Solution
Let the equation of the plane be
B and C are (a, 0, 0), (0, b, 0) and (0, 0, c). The centroid is
centroid is given as (1, 2, 4).
But the
620
Let the line joining the points P(2, 3, 5) and Q(3, 4, 7) be divided by the
plane in the ratio :1.
Then
Therefore, the points lie on the opposite sides of the plane.
Example 12.31
Find the distance between the parallel planes 2x 2y + z + 3 = 0, 4x 4y +
2z + 5 = 0.
Solution
Let (x1, y1, z1) be a point on the plane 2x 2y + z + 3 = 0
Then the distance between the parallel planes is equal to the distance from
(x1, y1, z1) to the other plane.
621
Example 12.32
A plane is drawn through the line of x + y = 1, z = 0 to make an
angle
with the plane x + y +z = 0. Prove that two such planes can
be drawn. Find their equation. Show that the angle between the planes
is
Solution
The equation of the plane through the line
The direction ratios of this plane is 1, 1, . Also the direction ratios of the
plane x + y + z = 0 are 1, 1, 1. If is the angle between these two planes then
Example 12.33
Find the bisectors of the angles between the planes 2x y + 2z + 3 = 0, 3x
2y + 6z + 8 = 0; also find out which plane bisects the acute angle.
622
Solution
The two given planes are
Let be the angle between the planes (12.64) and (12.66) then
623
16 + 9 2 + 18 9 = 0
Hence, the given equation represents a pair of planes. Let be the angle
between the planes. Then
Exercises
Section A
1. If P is the point (2, 3, 1), find the equation of the plane passing through P and
perpendicular toOP.
Ans.: 2x + 3y z 14 = 0
2. The foot of the perpendicular from the origin to a plane is (12, 4, 3). Find its
equation.
Ans.: 12x 4y 3z + 69 = 0
Ans.:
624
4. A plane meets the coordinate axes at A, B and C such that the centroid of the
triangle is the point (a, b, c). Show that the equation of the plane is
5. Find the equation of the plane that passes through the point (2, 3, 1) and is
perpendicular to the line joining the points (3, 4, 1) and (2, 1, 5).
Ans.: x + 5y 6z + 19 = 0
6. O is the orgin and A is the point (a, b, c). Find the equation of the plane
perpendicular to A.
8. Show that the points (0, 1, 1), (4, 5, 1),(3, 9, 4) and (4, 4, 4) lie on a plane.
9. Show that the points (0, 1, 0), (2, 1, 1), (1, 1, 1) and (3, 3, 0) are coplanar.
10. Find the equation of the plane through the three points (2, 3, 4), (3, 5, 1) and
(4, 1, 2). Also find the angles which the normal to the plane makes with the
axes of reference.
Ans.:
11. Find the equation of the plane which passes through the point (2, 3, 4) and is
parallel to the plane 2x 5y 7z + 15 = 0.
Ans.: 2x 5y 7z + 9 = 0
12. Find the equation of the plane through (1, 3, 2) and perpendicular to the
planes x + 2y + 2z 5 = 0 and 3x + 3y + 3z 8 = 0.
Ans.: 2x 4y + 3z + 8 = 0
13. Find the equation of the plane which passes through the point (2, 2, 4) and
perpendicular to the planes 2x 2y 4z + 3 = 0 and 3x + y + 6z 4 = 0.
Ans.: x 3y z 4 = 0
625
14. Find the equation of the plane which passes through the points (9, 3, 6) and (2,
2, 1) and perpendicular to the plane 2x + 4y + 6z 9 = 0.
Ans.: 3x + 4y 5z 9 = 0
15. Find the equation of the straight line passing through the points (1, 1, 1) and
(1, 1, 1) and perpendicular to the plane x + 2y + 2z 5 = 0.
Ans.: 2x + 2y 3z + 3 = 0
16. Find the equation of the plane which passes through the points (2, 3, 1), (4, 5,
3) and are parallel to the coordinate axes.
Ans.: y + 4z 7 = 0, x z 1 = 0, 4x + y 11 = 0
17. Find the equation of the plane which passes the point (1, 2, 3) and parallel to
3x + 4y 5z = 0.
Ans.: 3x + 4y 5z + 4 = 0
18. Find the equation of the plane bisecting the line joining the points (2, 3, 1)
and (5, 6, 3) at right angles.
Ans.: x y z + 7 = 0
19. A variable plane is at a constant distance p from the origin and meets the axes
in A, B and C. Show that the locus of centroid of the tetrahedron OABC is
x2 + y2 + z2 = 16p2.
Ans.:
23. Find the distance between the parallel planes 2x + y + 2z 8 = 0 and 4x + 2y +
4z + 5 = 0.
626
Ans.:
24. Find the locus of the point, the sum of the squares of whose distances from the
planes x + y + z= 0, x = z = 0, x 2y + z = 0 is 9.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 = 9
25. Find the equation of the plane which is at a distance 1 unit from the origin and
parallel to the plane 3x + 2y z + 2 = 0.
Ans.:
Ans.: y2 2xz = 0
30. Find the locus of the point whose distance from the origin is 7 times its
distance from the plane 2x + 3y 6z = 2.
31. Prove that the equation of the plane passing through the points (1, 1, 1), (1, 1,
1) and (7, 3, 5) and is parallel to axis of y.
32. Determine the constant k so that the planes x 2y + kz = 0 and 2x + 5y z = 0
are at right angles, and in that case find the plane through the point (1, 1, 1)
and perpendicular to both the given planes.
Ans.: k = 8, 14x 5y + 3z 16 = 0
627
33. Prove that 3x y z + 11 = 0 is the equation of the plane through (1, 6, 2) and
perpendicular to the join of the points (1, 2, 3) and (2, 3, 4).
34. A, B and C are points (a, 0, 0), (0, b, 0) and (0, 0, c). Find the equation of the
plane through BCwhich bisects OA. By symmetry write down the equations of
the plane through CA bisecting OBand through AB bisecting OC. Show that
these planes pass through
Section B
1. Find the equation of the plane through the intersection of the planes x + 3y + 6
= 0 and 3x y 4z = 0 whose perpendicular distance from the origin is unity.
Ans.: 2x + y 2z + 3 = 0, x 2y 2z 3 = 0
2. Find the equation of the plane through the intersection of the planes x 2y +
3z + 4 = 0 and 2x 3y + 4z 7 = 0 and the point (1, 1, 1).
3. Find the equation of the plane through the intersection of the planes x + 2y +
3z + 4 = 0 and 4x+ 3y + 3z + 1 = 0 and perpendicular to the plane x + y + z + 9
= 0 and show that it is perpendicular to xz-plane.
Ans.: x z = 2
4. Find the equation of the plane through the point (1, 2, 3) and the intersection
of the planes 2x y + 4z 7 = 0 and x + 2y 3z + 8 = 0.
5. Find the equation of the plane passing through the intersection of the
planes x + 2y + 3z + 4 = 0 and 4x + 3y + 2z + 1 = 0 and through the point (1, 2,
3).
Ans.: 11x + 4y 3z 10 = 0
6. Find the equation of the plane passing through the line of intersection of the
planes x 2y z + 3 = 0 and 3x + 5y 2z 1 = 0 which is perpendicular to
the yz-plane.
Ans.: 11y + z 10 = 0
628
Ans.:
9. Find the equation of the plane passing through the line of intersection of the
planes 2x y = 0 and 3x y = 0 an perpendicular to the plane 4x + 3y 3z =
8.
10. Find the equation of the plane passing through the line of intersection of the
planes ax + by + cz+ d = 0 and a1x + b1y + c1z + d1 = 0 perpendicular to xyplane.
11. Find the equation of the plane passing through the line of intersection of the
planes 2x + 3y + 10z 8 = 0, 2x 3y + 7z 2 = 0 and is perpendicular to the
plane 3x 2y + 4z 5 = 0.
Ans.: 2y + z 2 = 0
12. Obtain the equation of the planes bisecting the angles between the planes x +
2y 2z + 1 = 0 and 12x 4y + 3z + 5 = 0. Also show that these two planes are
at right angles.
13. Find the equation of the plane that bisects the angle between the planes 3x
6y 2z + 5 = 0 and 4x 12y + 3z 3 = 0 which contain the origin. Does this
plane bisect the acute angle?
14. Find the equation of the plane that bisects the acute angle between the planes
3x 4y + 12z 26 = 0 and x + 2y 2z 9 = 0.
629
Ans.: 8x 14y 13 = 0
16. Show that the origin lies in the acute angle between the planes x + 2y 2z 9
= 0, 4x 3y + 12z+ 13 = 0. Find the planes bisecting the angle between them
and find the plane which bisects the acute angle.
17. Find the equation of the plane which bisects the acute angle between the
planes x + 2y + 2z 3 = 0 and 3x + 4y + 12z + 1 = 0.
18. Prove that the equation 2x2 6y2 12z2 + 18yz + 2zx + xy = 0 represents a pair
of planes and show that the angle between them is
19. Prove that the equation
represents a pair of planes.
2
2
2
20. If the equation (x, y, z) = ax + by + cz + 2fyz + 2gzx + 2hxy = 0 represents a
pair of planes then prove that the product of the distances of the planes
from
630
Chapter 13
Straight Line
13.1 INTRODUCTION
The intersection of two planes P1 and P2 is the locus of all the common
points on both the planes P1and P2. This locus is a straight line. Any given
line can be uniquely determined by any of the two planes containing the
line. Thus, a line can be regarded as the locus of the common points of two
intersecting planes.
Let us consider the two planes
Let A(x1, y1, z1) be a point on the straight line and P(x, y, z) be any point on
the straight line. Let l, m, n be the direction cosines of the straight line.
Let OP = r. The projections of AP on the coordinate axes
are x x1, y y1, z z1. Also the projections of AP on the coordinate axes are
given by lr, mr, nr. Then x x1 = lr, y y1 = mr and z z1 = nr.
631
These equations are called the symmetrical form of the straight line.
Aliter:
We now derive the equations in symmetrical form from the vector equation
of the straight line passing through a point and parallel to a vector.
Let A be a given point on a straight line and P be any point on the straight
line. Let be a vector parallel to the line. Let O be the origin
and
Then
But
where t is a scalar.
From (13.3) and (13.4),
632
This equation is true for all positions of P on the straight line and therefore
this is the vector equation of the straight line.
Let
Then from equation (13.4), we have
These are the cartesian equations of the straight line in symmetrical form.
Note 13.2.1: To express the equations of a straight line in symmetrical
form we require (i) the coordinate of a point on the line and (ii) the
direction cosines of the straight line.
Note 13.2.2: Any point on this line is (x1 + lr, y1 + mr, z1 + nr). Even
if l, m and n are the direction ratios of the line, (x1 + lr, y1 + mr, z1 + nr) will
represent a point on the line but r will not be distance between the points
(x, y, z) and (x1, y1, z1).
13.3 EQUATIONS OF A STRAIGHT LINE PASSING THROUGH THE TWO GIVEN POINTS
Let P(x1, y1, z1) and Q(x2, y2, z2) be two given points. The direction ratios of
the line are x2 x1, y2 y1,z2 z1.
Therefore, the equations of the straight line are
Aliter:
Let O be the origin and P and Q be the points on the straight line and R be
any point on the straight line.
633
Then
But
634
To find a point on the line, let us find the point where the line meets the
plane. z = 0 and a1x + b1y +d = 0 and a1x + b1y + d1 = 0. Solving the last two
equations, we get
Note 13.4.1: We can also find the point where the line meets the yzplane
or zxplane.
13.5 ANGLE BETWEEN A PLANE AND A LINE
Let be the angle between the plane and the line. The direction ratios of the
normal to the plane area, b, c. The direction ratios of the line are l, m, n.
Since is the angle between the plane and the line,
between the normal to the plane and the line.
is the angle
635
al + bm + cn = 0
13.6 CONDITION FOR A LINE TO BE PARALLEL TO A PLANE
If the line is parallel to the plane then the normal to the plane is
perpendicular to the line. The condition for this is
Since (x1, y1, z1) is a point on the line and does not lie on the plane given
by (13.10).
636
Since the line lies on the plane every point on the line is also a point on the
plane. (x1, y1, z1) is a point on the line and therefore it should also lie on the
plane given by (13.14). Hence, ax1 + by1 + cz1 + d = 0. Therefore, the
conditions for the line (13.13) to be parallel to the plane (13.14) are al + bm
+ cn = 0 and ax1 + by1 + cz1 + d = 0.
13.8 TO FIND THE LENGTH OF THE PERPENDICULAR FROM A GIVEN POINT ON A LINE
Then L(x1, y1, z1) is a point on the line. Draw PM perpendicular to the line.
637
Since the plane also contains the line (13.21) the point (x2, y2, z2) lies on the
plane (13.22).
638
This is the required condition for the lines (13.20) and (13.21) to be
coplanar.
Eliminating a, b, c from the equation (13.23), (13.24) and (13.25), we get
the equation of the plane containing the two given lines
as
Aliter:
If the planes are coplanar they may intersect. Any point on the
line (13.20) is x1 + l1r1, y1 + m1r1, z1 +n1r1. Any point on the
line (13.21) is x2 + l2r2, y2 + m2r2, z2 + n2r2.
If the two lines intersect then the two points are the same.
639
Two nonintersecting and nonparallel lines are called skew lines. There
also exists a shortest distance between the skew lines and the line of the
shortest distance which is common perpendicular to both of these.
13.10.1 Length and Equations of the Line of the Shortest Distance
Let the equation of the skew lines be
640
Therefore, the equation of the line of the SD is the intersection of these two
planes and its equations are given by
Note 13.10.1: If the lines (13.28) and (13.29) are coplanar then the SD
between the lines is zero. Hence the condition for the
lines (13.28) and (13.29) to be coplanar,
from (13.30) is
Aliter:
Let the vector equations of the two lines be
641
If the lines (13.33) and (13.34) are coplanar then the plane is parallel to the
vectors and . Thereby
is perpendicular to the plane
containing and . Also as and are the points on the plane,
is a
line on the plane and is perpendicular to
. The condition for this
is
or
. The vector
or
.
and
and
,
642
is
and PQ is
643
We will now show that the equations of any two skew lines can be part into
the form y = mx, z = cand y = mx, z = c.
644
angle ,
and with x, y, zaxes. Its direction cosines are cos,
sin, 0. The coordinates of L are (0, 0, c). AB is a straight line passing
through Land parallel to AB. The equations of the
line OP are
or y = xtan, z = c
and
Three planes may intersect in a line or a point. Let us find the conditions
for three given planes to intersect (i) in a line and (ii) in a point.
Let the equations of three given planes be
645
Therefore, the conditions for the three planes to intersect in a line are 1 =
0, 2 = 0, 3 = 0 and 4 = 0.
Note 13.12.1: Of these four conditions only two are independent since if
two planes have two points in common then they show the line joining
these two points should also have in common. It can be proved if any two of
these conditions are satisfied, then the other two will also satisfy.
Aliter:
The equations of the line of intersection of (13.37) and (13.38) are given by
646
If the planes (13.37), (13.38) and (13.39) intersect in a plane then the
conditions are (i) the line (13.41)must be parallel to the plane (13.39) and
(ii) the point
The conditions for (13.37) is
647
648
ILLUSTRATIVE EXAMPLES
Example 13.1
Find the equation of the line joining the points (2, 3, 5) and (1, 2, 4).
Solution
The direction ratios of the line are 2 + 1, 3 2, 5 + 4 (i.e.) 3, 1, 9. Therefore,
the equations of the line are
Example 13.2
Find the equation of the line passing through the point (3, 2, 6) and
perpendicular to the plane 3x y 2z + 2 = 0.
Solution
The direction ratios of the line are the direction ratios of the normal to the
plane. Therefore, the direction ratios of the line are 3, 1, 2. Given that (4,
2, 6) is a point on the plane.
Therefore, the equations of the line are
Example 13.3
Find the equations of the line passing through the point (1, 2, 3) and
perpendicular to the planes x 2y z + 5 = 0 and x + y + 3z + 6 = 0.
Solution
Let l, m, n be the direction ratios of the line of intersection of the planes x
2y z + 5 = 0 and x + y+ 3z + 6 = 0.
Then
and
l 2m n = 0
l + m + 3n = 0
649
Since the line also passes through the point (1, 2, 3), its equations
is
Example 13.4
Express the symmetrical form of the equations of the line x + 2y + z 3 =
0, 6x + 8y + 3z 13 = 0.
Solution
To express the equations of a line in symmetrical form we have to find (i)
the direction ratios of the line and (ii) a point on the line.
Let l, m, n be the direction ratios of line. Then l + 2m + n = 0 and 6l + 8m +
3n = 0.
Let us find the point where the line meets the xyplane (i.e.) z = 0.
650
Any point on this line are (5r + 13, 8r 8, r + 31). Draw PQ perpendicular
to the plane. The direction ratios of the line are (5r + 12, 8r 11, r + 32).
Since the line PQ is perpendicular to QR, we have
Example 13.6
Find the equation of plane passing through the line
parallel to the line
Solution
Any plane containing the line
and
651
is
where
or
(i.e.) 11x + 2y 5z + 6 = 0
Example 13.7
Find the image of the point (2, 3, 5) on the plane 2x + y z + 2 = 0.
Solution
Let Q be the image of the point P(2, 3, 5) on the plane 2x + y z + 2 = 0.
The equation of the line PQis
Any point on this line is (2r + 2, r + 3, r + 5). When the line meets the
plane, this point lies on the plane 2x + y z + 2 = 0.
652
Example 13.8
Find the image of the line
0.
in the plane 2x y + z + 3 =
Solution
The equations of the line are
653
Any point on this line is (2r1 + 1, r1 + 3, r1 + 4). If this point lies on the
plane (13.48), we get 2(2r1 + 1) (r1 + 3) + (r1 + 4) + 3 = 0.
(i.e.) 6r1 + 6 = 0 or r1 = 1.
Therefore, the coordinates of L where this line meets the plane (13.47) are
(1, 4, 3). If Q (x1, y1, z1) is the image of P in the plane
Example 13.9
Find the equation of the straight lines through the origin each of which
intersects the straight line
to it.
Solution
654
and
Example 13.10
Find the coordinates of the point where the line given by x + 3y z =
6, y z = 4 cuts the plane 2x + 2y + z = 6.
Solution
Let l, m, n be the direction cosines of the line x + 3y z = 6, y z = 4. Then
655
is
656
Example 13.12
Prove that the equation of the line through the points (a, b, c) and
(a, b, c) passes through the origin if aa + bb + cc =
pp where p and p are the distances of the points from the origin.
Solution
The equations of the line through (a, b, c) and (a, b, c) are
Let p and p be the distances of the points (a, b, c) and (a, b, c) from the
origin.
By Lagranges identity,
Example 13.13
657
that
Solution
The equation of the line OA is
Example 13.14
Reduce the equations of the lines x = ay + b, z = cy + d to symmetrical form
and hence find the condition that the line be perpendicular to the line
whose equations are x = ay + b, z = cy + d.
Solution
658
The line
The line
in symmetrical form is
. Similarly, Y is
and Z is
659
(13.56)
Then
Here, r is the distance of G from the plane (13.55) since p and l2 are
positive, r = GA
Example 13.16
Find the perpendicular distance of angular points of a cube from a diagonal
which does not pass through the angular point.
Solution
660
Let a be the side of the cube. BB is a diagonal of the cube not passing
through O. The direction ratios of BB are a, a, a. (i.e.) 1, 1, 1. The
direction cosines of BB are
Example 13.17
Prove that the equations of the line through the point (, , ) and at right
angles to the lines
are
Solution
Let l, m, n be the direction cosines of the line perpendicular to the two
given lines. Then we have
661
Ans.: x + y + z = 0
3. Find the equation of the plane which passes through the line 3x + 5y + 7z 5 =
0 = x + y + z 3 and parallel to the line 4x + y + z = 0 = 2x 3y 5z.
Ans.: 2x + 4y + y + 6z = 2
4. Find the equations of the line through the point (1, 0, 7) which intersect each of
the lines
Ans.: 7x 6y z = 0, 9x 7y z 2 = 0
5. Find the equation of the plane which passes through the point (5, 1, 2) and is
perpendicular to the line
point in which this line cuts the plane.
Ans.: x 2y 2z 1 = 0; (1, 2, 3)
6. Find the equation of the plane through (1, 1, 2) and (2, 10, 1) and
perpendicular to the straight line
Ans.: 3x y 7z + 2 = 0
7. Find the projection of the line 3x y + 2z = 1, x + 2y z = 2 on the plane 3x +
2y + z = 0.
Ans.: 3x + 2y + z = 0, 3x 8y + 7z + 4 = 0
Ans.:
9. Find the equation of the plane which contains the line and is perpendicular to
the plane x + 2y+ z = 12.
Ans.: 9x 2y 5z + 4 = 0
662
10. Find the equation of the plane which passes through the zaxis and is
perpendicular to the line
and distant
Ans.: x + 2y 2z = 0, 2x + 2y + z = 0
12. Find the equations to the line of the greatest slope through the point (1, 2, 1)
in the plane x 2y + 3z = 0 assuming that the axes are so placed that the plane
2x + 3y 4z = 0 is horizontal.
Ans.:
13. Assuming the line
as vertical, find the equation of the line of the
greatest slope in the plane 2x + y 5z = 12 and passing through the point (2, 3,
1).
Ans.:
Ans.:
15. Show that the lines
will be coplanar
if
16. Show that the equation of the plane through the line
perpendicular to the plane containing the lines
(m n)x = 0.
17. Show that the line
if = or = or = .
and
and which is
and
is
663
18. Find the equation of the plane passing through the line
perpendicular to the plane x + 2y + z = 12.
and
Ans.: 9x 2y + 5z + 4 = 0
19. Find the equations of the line through (3, 4, 0) and perpendicular to the plane
2x + 4y + 7z = 8.
Ans.:
20. Find the equation of the plane passing through the line
parallel to the line
are
Ans.: 4y 3z + 1 = 0, 2x 7z + 1 = 0, 3x 2y + 1 = 0.
21. Show that the equation of the planes through the line which bisect the angle
between the lines
(where l, m, n and l, m, n are direction
cosines) and perpendicular to the plane containing them are (l + l)x +
(m + m)y + (n + n)z = 0.
22. Find the equation of the plane through the line
the coordinate planes.
and parallel to
23. Prove that the plane through the point (, , ) and the
line x = py + q = zx + r is given by
Ans.:
Exercises 2
1. Find the equation of the line joining the points
664
Ans.:
2. Find the equations of the line passing through the point (3, 2, 8) and is
perpendicular to the plane 3x y 2z + 2 = 0.
Ans.:
3. Find the equations of the line passing through the point (3, 1, 6) and parallel
to each of the planes x + y + 2z 4 = 0 and 2x 3y + z + 5 = 0.
Ans.:
4. Find the equations of the line through the point (1, 2, 3) and parallel to the line
of intersection of the planes x 2y z + 5 = 0, x + y + 3z 6 = 0.
Ans.:
5. Find the point at which the line
1 = 0.
Ans.:
6. Find the coordinates of the point at which the line
plane 2x + 3y + z = 0.
meets the
Ans.:
7. Prove that the equations of the normal to the plane ax + by + cz + d = 0
through the point (, ,) are
8. Express in symmetrical form the following lines:
0.
1.
2.
x + 2y + z = 3, 6x + 8y + 3z = 13
x 2y + 3z 4 = 0, 2x 3y + 4z 5 = 0
x + 3y z 15 = 0, 5x 2y + 4z + 8 = 0
Ans.:
665
Ans.: 21
14. Find the distance of the point (1, 5, 10) from the point of intersection of the
line
Ans.: 13
15. Find the length of the perpendicular from the point (5, 4, 1) to the
line
Ans.:
16. Find the foot of the perpendicular from the point (1, 11, 5) to the
line
Ans.:
17. Obtain the coordinates of the foot of the perpendicular from the origin on the
line joining the points (9, 4, 5) and (11, 0, 1).
18. Find the image of the point (4, 5, 2) in the plane x y + 3z 4 = 0.
Ans.: (6, 3, 4)
Ans.: (1, 0, 7)
666
Ans.:
21. Find the image of the point (p, q, r) in the plane 2x + y + z = 6 and hence find
the image of the line
Ans.:
22. Find the coordinates of the foot of the perpendicular from (1, 0, 2) to the
line
Ans.:
23. Find the equation in symmetrical form of the projection of the
line
Ans.:
24. Prove that the point which the line
meets the plane 2x + 35y
39z + 12 = 0 is equidistant from the planes 12x 15y + 16z = 28 and 6x + 6y
7z = 8.
25. Find the equation of the projection of the straight line
plane x + y + 2z = 5 in symmetrical form.
on the
Ans.:
26. Prove that two lines in which the planes 3x 7y 5z = 1 and 5x 13y + 3z + 2
= 0 cut the plane 8x 11y + 2z = 0 include a right angle.
27. Reduce to symmetrical form the line given by the equations x + y + z + 1 = 0,
4x + y 2z + 2 = 0. Hence find the equation of the plane through (1, 1, 1) and
perpendicular to the given line.
Ans.:
28. Show that the line x + 2y z 3 = 0, x + 3y z 4 = 0 is parallel to the xz
plane and find the coordinates of the point where it meets yzplane.
Ans.: (0, 1, 1)
667
Ans.:
30. Find the equation of the plane passing through the line
parallel to the line
and
Ans.: 11x + 2y 5z + 6 = 0
31. The plane
meets the axes in A, B and C. Find the coordinates of the
orthocentre of the ABC.
Ans.:
32. The equation to a line AB are
. Through a point P(1, 2, 3), PN is drawn
perpendicular toAB and PQ is drawn parallel to the plane 2x + 3y + 4z = 0 to
meet AB in Q. Find the equations of PN and PQ and the coordinates
of N and Q.
Ans.:
ILLUSTRATIVE EXAMPLES (COPLANAR LINES AND SHORTEST DISTANCE)
Example 13.18
Prove that the lines
and
are coplanar and
find the equation of the plane continuing these two lines.
Solution
(1, 10, 1) is a point on the first line and 3, 8, 2 are the direction ratios of
the first line. (3, 1, 4) is a point on the second line and 4, 7, 1 are the
direction ratios of the second line. If the lines are coplanar
then
668
Therefore, the two lines are coplanar. The equation of the plane containing
the lines is
Example 13.19
Show that the lines
and
intersect. Find the
point of intersection and the equation of the plane containing these two
lines.
Solution
The two given lines are
Any point on the first line is (3r 1, 2r + 3, r 2). Any point on the
second line is (r1, 3r1 + 7, 2r1 7). If the two lines intersect then the two
points are one and the same.
669
Example 13.20
Show that the lines
and x + 2y + 3z 8 = 0, 2x + 3y + 4z
11 = 0 are coplanar. Find the equation of the plane containing these two
lines.
Solution
The two lines are
670
If the line given by (13.62) lies on this plane then the point (1, 1, 1) also
lies on the plane.
Also the normal to this plane should be perpendicular to the line (13.62).
The direction ratios of the normal to the plane are 4, 1, 2. The direction
ratios of the line (13.62) are 1, 2, 3. Also ll1 + mm1 + nn1= 4 + 2 6 = 0
which is true. Hence, the plane containing the two given lines is 4x + y
2z + 3 = 0. Any point on the first line is (r 1, 2r 1, 3r 1). If the two
given lines intersect at this point then it should lie on the second line and
hence on the plane x + 2y + 3z 8 = 0.
Therefore, the point of intersection of the two given lines is (0, 1, 2).
Example 13.21
Show that the lines x + 2y + 3z 4 = 0, 2x + 3y + 4z 5 = 0 and 2x + 3y +
3z 5 = 0, 3x 2y + 4z 6 = 0 are coplanar and find the equation of the
plane containing the two lines.
Solution
Let us express the first line in symmetrical form. Let l, m, n be the direction
cosines of the first line. Then this line is perpendicular to the normals of the
planes x + 2y + 3z 4 = 0 and 2x + 3y + 4z 5 = 0.
671
Solving, we get
Therefore, the direction ratios of the first line are 1, 2, 1.
To find a point on the first line let us find where this line meets
the XOY plane (i.e.) z = 0.
If the plane contains the second line then the point (2, 3, 0) should lie on
the plane (13.67).
Also it should satisfy the condition. That the normal to the plane should be
perpendicular to the line(13.66).
The direction ratios of the normal to the plane (13.68) are 1, 1, 1.
The direction ratios of the line are 1, 2, 1. Also 1 2 + 1 = 0 which is
satisfied. Hence the equation of the required plane is x + y + z 1 = 0.
Example 13.22
672
Example 13.23
Prove that the lines a1x + b1y + c1z + d1 = 0
= a2x + b2y + c2z + d2 and a3x + b3y + c3z + d3 = 0 = a4x +b4y + c4z + d4 are
coplanar if
Solution
Let the two lines intersect at (x1, y1, z1). Then (x1, y1, z1) should lie on the
planes containing these lines.
673
and
Solution
The two given lines are
and
The coordinates of any point P on the first line are (3r 7, 4r 4, 2r 3).
The coordinates of any point Q on the second line are (6r1 + 21, 4r1 5,
r + 2).
The direction ratios of the line PQ are 3r 6r1 28, 4r + 4r1 + 1, 2r + r1
5.
If PQ is the line of the shortest distance then the two lines are
perpendicular. The direction ratios of the two lines are 3, 4, 2 and 6, 4,
1. Then 3(3r 6r1 28) + 4(4r + 4r1 + 1) 2(2r + r1 5) = 0 and 6(3r
6r1 2r) 4(4r + 4r1 + 1) 1(2r + r1 8) = 0
674
(i.e.)
Example 13.25
Show that the shortest distance between zaxis and the line of intersection
of the plane 2x + 3y + z 1 = 0 with 3x + 2y + z 2 = 0 is
units.
Solution
The equations of the plane containing the given line is
= 4
675
Example 13.26
Find the points on the lines
and
which are
nearest to each other. Hence find the shortest distance between the lines
and also its equation.
Solution
The given lines are
Any point on the line (13.71) is P(3r + 6, r + 7, r + 4). Any point on the
line (13.72) is Q( 3r1, 2r1 9, 4r1 + 2). The direction ratios of PQ are (3r +
3r1 + 6, r 2r1 + 16, r 4r1 + 2).
Since PQ is perpendicular to the two given lines.
Therefore, the points P and Q are (3, 8, 3) and (3, 7, 6). The SD is the
distance PQ.
676
Example 13.27
Find the shortest distance between the
lines
and
line of the shortest distance.
Solution
Let l, m, n be the direction ratios of the line of the SD. Since it is
perpendicular to both the lines
The direction ratios of the line of SD are 2, 3, 6. The direction cosines of the
line of SD are
The length of the line of the SD = |(x1 x2)l + (y1 y2)m + (z1 z2)n| where
(x1, y1, z1) and (x2, y2, z2) are the direction cosines of the line of SD.
The equation of the plane containing the first line and the line of SD is
677
The equation of the plane containing the second line and the line of SD is
and y =
Solution
The two given lines are
678
Hence from (13.75), the equation of the plane containing line (13.73) and
parallel to the plane (13.74)is
Then the SD between the given lines = the perpendicular distance from any
point on the line (13.74)to the plane (13.75).
(0, 0, c) is a point on the line (13.76).
Example 13.29
Show that the shortest distance between any two opposite edges of the
tetrahedron formed by the planes y + z = 0, z + x = 0, x + y = 0
and x + y + z = a is
and the three lines of the shortest distance intersect
at the point x + y + z = a.
Solution
The equations of the edge determined by the planes y + z = 0, z + x = 0 is
679
Let l, m, n be the direction cosines of the line of the SD between two lines.
Then l + m n = 0, l m + 0. n = 0.
Solving for l, m, n we get
The equation of the plane containing the edge given by (13.77) and the line
of the SD is
This line passes through the point (a, a, a). Similarly, by symmetry we note
that the other two lines ofSD also pass through the point (a, a, a).
Example 13.30
A square ABCD of diagonal 2a is folded along the diagonal AC, so that the
planes DAC, BAC are at right angles. Find the shortest distance
between DC and AB.
Solution
Let a be the side of the square. Let us take OB, OC, OD as the axes of
coordinates. The coordinates ofB, C, D and A are (a, 0, 0), (0, a, 0), (0,
0, a), (0, 0, a).
680
The equations of the plane passing through the straight line (13.80) and
parallel to (13.81) is
Example 13.31
Prove that the shortest distance between the diagonal of rectangular
parallelepiped and the edge not meeting it
is
Solution
681
Hence, l, m, n are c, o, a.
The direction cosines of the line of the SD are
and
Exercises 3
1. Prove that the lines
and
the equation of the plane containing the line.
Ans.: x y + z = 0
682
Ans.:
Ans.: (5, 7, 6)
Ans.: x 2y + z = 0
Ans.: x 2y + z = 0
Ans.: 6x 5y z = 0
Ans.:
683
Ans.: x + 2y + 3z 2 = 0.
Ans.: x 2y + z = 0
Ans.:
16. Show that the lines
and x + 2y + 3z 14 = 0, 3x + 4y + 5z 26
= 0 are coplanar. Find their point of intersection and the equation of the plane
containing them.
684
Ans.: x + y + z 1 = 0
20. Show that the equation of the plane through the line
perpendicular to the plane containing the lines
n) x + (n l) y + (l m) z = 0.
21. Prove that the lines
and which is
and
and ax + by + cz + d =
is (m
.
and
are coplanar
if
.
23. A, A; B, B and C, C are points on the axes, show that the lines of intersection
of the planes (ABC, ABC), (BCA, BCA) and (CAB, CAB) are coplanar.
24. Find the shortest distance between the
lines
the SD.
Ans.:
and
, 4x + y 5z = 0, 9x + y 8z 31 = 0
Ans.:
Ans.:
685
27. Show that the shortest distance between zaxes and the line of intersection of
the plane 2x + 3y+ 4z 1 = 0 with 3x + 2y + z 2 = 0 is
28. Show that the shortest distance between the
lines
and
2y 7z + 6 = 0, 7x + y 3z + 7 = 0.
is
29. Find the length of the shortest distance between the lines
2x + 3y 6z 6 = 0, 3x 2y z + 5 = 0.
and
Ans.:
30. Find the shortest distance between zaxis and the line ax + by + cz + d =
0, ax + by + cz + d= 0.
Ans.:
31. Find the shortest distance between an edge of a cube and a diagonal which
does not meet it.
Ans.:
32. A line with direction cosines proportional to 1, 7, 5 is drawn to intersect the
lines
and
. Find the coordinates of the point of
intersection and the length intercepted on it.
686
abd sin.
36. Show that the equation of the plane containing the line x = 0,
parallel to the line y = 0,
is
and
687
Chapter 14
Sphere
14.1 DEFINITION OF SPHERE
The locus of a moving point in space such that its distance from a fixed
point is constant is called a sphere. The fixed point is called the centre of
the sphere. The constant distance is called the radius.
14.2 THE EQUATION OF A SPHERE WITH CENTRE AT (A, B, C) AND RADIUS R
Let P(x, y, z) be any point on the sphere. Let C(a, b, c) be the centre.
Then,
688
This equation shows that this is the locus of a point (x, y, z) moving from
the fixed point (u, v, w) keeping a constant distance
from
it.
Therefore, the locus is a sphere whose centre is (u, v, w) and whose
radius is
.
Note 14.2.1: A general equation of second degree in x, y, z will represent a
sphere if (i) coefficients ofx2, y2, z2 are the same and (ii) the coefficients
of xy, yz, zx are zero.
14.3 EQUATION OF THE SPHERE ON THE LINE JOINING THE POINTS (X1, Y1, Z1) AND
(X2, Y2, Z2) AS DIAMETER
Find the equation of the sphere on the line joining the points
(x1, y1, z1) and (x2, y2, z2) as the extremities of a diameter.
A (x1, y1, z1) and B (x2, y2, z2) be the ends of a diameter. Let (x, y, z) be any
point on the surface of the sphere.
Then APB = 90
Therefore, AP is perpendicular to BP.
The direction ratios of AP are x x1, y y1, z z1.
The direction ratios of BP are x x2, y y2, z z2.
Since AP is perpendicular to BP,
689
14.4 LENGTH OF THE TANGENT FROM P(X1, Y1, Z1) TO THE SPHERE X2+ Y2 + Z2 + 2UX +
2VY + 2WZ + D = 0
Find the length of the tangent from P(x1, y1, z1) to the
sphere x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0.
The centre of the sphere is (u, v, w).
The radius of the sphere is
Note 14.4.1: If PT2 > 0, the point P lies outside the sphere.
If PT2 = 0, then the point P lies on the sphere.
If PT2 < 0, then the point P lies inside the sphere.
14.5 EQUATION OF THE TANGENT PLANE AT (X1, Y1, Z1) TO THE SPHERE X2 + Y2 + Z2 +
2UX + 2VY + 2WZ + D = 0
Find the equation of the tangent plane at (x1, y1, z1) to the
sphere x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy+ 2wz + d = 0.
The centre of the sphere is (u, v, w).
P(x1, y1, z1) is a point on the sphere and the required plane is a tangent plane
to the sphere at P.
Therefore, the direction ratios of CP are x1 + u, y1 + v, z1 + w.
690
Therefore, the equation of the tangent plane at (x1, y1, z1) is (x1 + u)(x x1) +
(y1 + v)(y y1) + (z1 +w)(z z1) = 0.
Let C be the centre of the sphere and P be any point on the section of the
sphere by the plane.
Draw CN perpendicular to the plane. Then N is the foot of the
perpendicular from P on the plane section.
Join CP. Since CN is perpendicular to NP, CNP is a right angled triangle.
691
Then any point on the circle lie on the sphere (14.1) as well as the plane
section (14.2). Hence, the equations of the circle of the sphere are given
by x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0 and ax + by + cz + k = 0.
14.8 INTERSECTION OF TWO SPHERES
692
This equation represents a sphere. Suppose (x1, y1, z1) is a point on the given
circle. Then
Equations (14.6) and (14.7) show that the point (x1, y1, z1) lies on the sphere
given by equation (14.5).
Since (x1, y1, z1) is an arbitrary point on the circle, it follows that every point
on the circle is a point on the sphere given by (14.5).
Hence equation (14.5) represents the equation of a sphere passing through
the circle (14.4).
14.10 CONDITION FOR ORTHOGONALITY OF TWO SPHERES
The centres of the spheres are A(u, v, w) and B(u1, v1, w1). The
radius
693
Two spheres are said to be orthogonal, if the tangent planes at this point of
intersection are at right angles.
(i.e.)
The radii drawn through the point of intersection are at right angles.
The locus of a point whose powers with respect to two spheres are equal is
called the radical plane of the two spheres.
14.11.1 Obtain the Equations to the Radical Plane of Two Given Spheres
Let the two given spheres be
Let (x1, y1, z1) be a point such that the power of this point with respect to
spheres (14.10) and (14.11)be equal. Then
694
Proof:
Let the equations of the two spheres be
The centres of the two spheres are
Proof:
Let S1 = 0, S2 = 0, S3 = 0 be the equations of the three given spheres
in each of which the coefficients of x2, y2 and z2 are unity.
Then the equations of the radical planes taken in pairs
are S1 S2 = 0, S2 S3 = 0, S3 S1 = 0.
695
These equation show that the radical planes of the three spheres
pass through the line S1 = S2 =S3.
Hence the result is proved.
Note 14.11.2.1: The line of concurrence of the three radical planes
is called radical line of the three spheres.
3. The radical planes of four spheres taken in pairs meet in a point.
Proof:
Let S1 = 0, S2 = 0, S3 = 0 and S4 = 0 be the equations of the four given
spheres, in each of which the coefficients of x2, y2, z2 are unity.
Then the equations of the radical planes taken two by two are
These equations show that the radical planes of the four spheres meet in at
a point given by S1 = S2 =S3 = S4.
Note 14.11.2.2: The point of concurrence of the radical planes of four
spheres is called the radical centre of the four spheres.
14.12 COAXAL SYSTEM
696
represent two spheres of the system with unit coefficients for x2, y2, z2 terms.
Therefore, the equation of the radical plane
of (14.18) and (14.19) is
697
Since the line of centres is the x-axis, is y and z coordinates are zero v =
0, w = 0.
Then the equation of the above sphere reduces to the form x2 + y2 + z2 +
2ux + d = 0.
Let us now consider two sphere of this system say, x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + d = 0
and x2 + y2 + z2 + 2u1x +d1 = 0.
The radical plane of these two spheres is
Therefore, the limiting points of the system of spheres given by (14.21) are (
,0,0) and ( , 0,0).
Note 14.12.3.1: Limiting points are real or imaginary according as d is
positive or negative.
698
699
Example 14.1
Find the equation of the sphere with centre at (2, 3, 4) and radius 5
units.
Solution
The equation of the sphere whose centre is (a, b, c) and radius r is (x a)2 +
(y b)2 + (z c)2 = r2. Therefore, the equation of the sphere whose centre is
(2, 3, 4) and radius 5 is (x 2)2 + (y + 3)2 + (z 4)2 = 52.
Example 14.2
Find the coordinate of the centre and radius of the sphere 16x2 + 16y2 +
16z2 16x 8y 16z 35 = 0.
Solution
The equation of the sphere is 16x2 + 16y2 + 16z2 16x 8y 16z 35 = 0.
Dividing by 16,
Centre of the sphere is
Example 14.3
Find the equation of the sphere with the centre at (1, 1, 2) and touching the
plane 2x 2y + z = 5.
700
Solution
The radius of the sphere is equal to the perpendicular distance from the
centre (1, 1, 2) on the plane 2x 2y + z 5 = 0.
The equation of the sphere with centre at (1, 1, 2) and radius 1 unit is (x
1)2 + (y 1)2 + (z 2)2 = 1.
(i.e.) x2 + y2 + z2 2x 2y 4z + 5 = 0
Example 14.4
Find the equation of the sphere passing through the points (1, 0, 0), (0, 1,
0), (0, 0, 1) and (0, 0, 0).
Solution
Let the equation of the sphere be x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0.
This passes through the points (1, 0, 0), (0, 1, 0), (0, 0, 1) and (0, 0, 0).
701
Centre is
702
Solution
Aliter:
The two given points are the extremities of a diameter of the sphere.
Therefore, the equation of the sphere is
Example 14.8
The plane
cuts the coordinate axes in A, B and C. Find the
equation of the sphere passing through A, B, C and O. Find also its centre
and radius.
Solution
The plane
cuts the coordinates of A, B and C. The coordinates
of A, B and C are (a, 0, 0), (0, b, 0) and (0, 0, c).
703
and
Solution
The faces of the tetrahedron are
Now easily seen that the vertices of the tetrahedron are (0, 0, 0), (a, b, c),
(a, b, c) and (a, b, c).
Let the equation of the sphere be x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0.
This sphere passes through the points (0, 0, 0), (a, b, c,), (a, b, c) and (
a, b, c).
704
Similarly,
Therefore, the equation of the sphere is x2 + y2 + z2
(a2 + b2+ c2)
Example 14.10
A sphere is inscribed in a tetrahedron whose faces are x = 0, y = 0, z = 0
and 2x + 6y + 3z = 14. Find the equation of the sphere. Also find its centre
and radius.
Solution
Let the equation of the sphere be x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0.
Since the sphere touches the plane x = 0, the perpendicular distance from
the centre (u, v, w) on this plane is equal to the radius.
u = r, v = r, w = r.
705
When
and radius = .
Example 14.11
Find the equation of the sphere passing through the points (1, 0, 1), (2, 1,
0), (1, 1, 1) and (1, 1, 1).
Solution
Let the equation of the sphere be x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0.
This sphere passes through (1, 0, 1), (2, 1, 0), (1, 1, 1) and (1, 1, 1).
706
From (14.31), 2 + d = 2 d = 0.
Therefore, the required equation of the circle is x2 + y2 + z2 2x y = 0.
Example 14.12
Find the equation of the sphere which touches the coordinate axes, whose
centre lies in the positive octant and has a radius 4.
Solution
Let the equation of the sphere be x2 + y2 + z2 + 2xu + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0.
The equation of the x- axis is
707
4u2 4d = 0 or u2 = d.
Similarly, v2 = d and w2 = d
The radius of the sphere is
(x + y + z) + 8 = 0.
Example 14.13
Find the radius and the equation of the sphere touching the plane 2x +
2y z = 0 and concentric with the sphere 2x2 + 2y2 + 2z2 + x + 2y z = 0.
Solution
Since the required sphere is concentric with the sphere 2x2 + 2y2 + 2z2 + x +
2y z = 0 its centre is the same as that of the given
sphere
Centre is
. The radius of the required sphere is equal to the
perpendicular distance from this point to the plane 2x + 2y z = 0.
708
Solution
Let the equation of the sphere be x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + k = 0.
This sphere passes through the points (1, 0, 0), (0, 2, 0) and (0, 0, 3).
Example 14.15
Find the equation of the sphere tangential to the plane x 2y 2z = 7 at (3,
1, 1) and passing through the point (1, 1, 3).
Solution
709
710
Therefore, the plane touches the sphere. The equations of the normal to the
tangent plane are
Any point on this line is
d=0
711
The sphere cuts the axes at A, B and C where it meets the x-axis.
y = 0, z = 0 x2 + 2ux = 0 x = 2u
Substituting in (14.35),
The point (x1, y1, z1) also lies on the plane (14.36)
712
or
The locus of
Example 14.18
A sphere of constant radius 2k passes through the origin and meets the axes
in A, B and C. Show that the locus of the centroid of the
tetrahedron OABC is x2 + y2 + z2 = k2.
Solution
Let the equation of the sphere be x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0.
This passes through the origin.
Since x 0, x = 2u.
Therefore, the coordinates of A are (2u, 0, 0).
Similarly the coordinates of B and C are (0, 2v, 0) and (0, 0, 2w).
Let (x1, y1, z1) be the centroid of the tetrahedron OABC.
713
u2 + v2 + w2 = 4r2
Using (14.40),
The locus of (x1, y1, z1) is the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = r2.
Example 14.19
A sphere of constant radius r passes through the origin and meets the axes
in A, B and C. Prove that the centroid of the triangle ABC lies on the sphere
9(x2 + y2 + z2) = 4r2.
Solution
Let the equation of the sphere be x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0.
This line passing through the origin.
d = 0.
x2 + 2ux = 0
714
as
x 0, x = 2u
from (14.41):
The locus of (x1, y1, z1) is 9(x2 + y2 + z2) = 4r2.
Example 14.20
A plane passes through the fixed point (a, b, c) and meets the axes in A, B,
C.
Prove that the locus of the centre of the sphere is
Solution
715
d=0
x2 + 2ux = 0. As x 0, x = 2u.
716
is
Any point on this line is t + 4, 2t 2, 2t 4. This point is the centre of the
circle then this lies on the plane x 2y + 2z 3 = 0 then t + 4 2(2t 2) +
2(2t 4) 3 = 0.
Example 14.22
Show that the centres of all sections of the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = r2 by planes
through the point (, , ) lie on the sphere x(x ) + y(y ) + z(z ) =
0.
Solution
Let (x1, y1, z1) be a centre of a section of the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = r2 by a plane
through (, , ). Then the equation of the plane is x1(x x1) + y1(y y1)
+ z1 (z z1) = 0. This plane passes through the point (, , ).
717
9(x2 + y2 z2 5) 10(x 2y + 2z 5) = 0.
Example 14.24
(x 2y + 2z 5)
718
If the sphere touches the plane 4x + 3y = 15 then the radius of the sphere is
equal to the perpendicular distance from the centre on the plane.
There are two spheres touching the given plane whose equations
are x2 + y2 + z2 5 + 2(x + 2y + 3z 3) = 0 and x2 + y2 + z2 5
3z 3) = 0
Example 14.25
(x + 2y +
719
These two values and satisfy (14.42), the equations (14.45) and (14.46).
Hence, the two given circles lie on the same sphere. The equation of the
sphere is x2 + y2 + z2 3x 4y + 5z 6 + x + 2y 7z = 0.
(i.e.) x2 + y2 + z2 2x 2y 2z 6 = 0
Example 14.26
The plane
meets the circle O, A, B and C. Find the equations of
the circumcircle of the triangle ABC and also find its centre.
720
Solution
The equation of the plane ABC is
Therefore, the coordinates of A, B and C are (a, 0, 0), (0, b, 0) and (0, 0, c)
respectively.
Also we know that the equation of the
sphere OABC is x2 + y2 + z2 ax by cz = 0.
Therefore, the equation of the circumcircle of the
triangle ABC are x2 + y2 + z2 ax by cz = 0 and
721
Example 14.27
Obtain the equations to the sphere through the common circle of the
sphere x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x + 2y = 0 and the plane x + y + z + 4 = 0 which
intersects the plane x + y = 0 in circle of radius 3 units.
Solution
The equation of the sphere containing the given circle is x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x +
2y + (x + y + z + 4) = 0.
Centre of this sphere is
722
Example 14.28
Find the equation of the sphere which touches the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x
6y + 1 = 0 at the point (1, 2, 2) and passes through the origin.
Solution
723
Example 14.29
Show that the condition for the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d =
0 to cut the sphere x2 +y2 + z2 + 2u1x + 2v1y + 2w1z + d1 = 0 in a great circle
is
Solution
Example 14.30
724
Example 14.31
Two spheres of radii r1 and r2 intersect orthogonally. Prove that the radius
of the common circle is
Solution
Let the equation of the common circle be
725
Example 14.32
Find the equation of the sphere which touches the plane 3x + 2y z + 2 = 0
at the point (1, 2, 1) and cuts orthogonally the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 4x +
6y + 4 = 0.
Solution
Let the equation of the required sphere be
726
727
(i.e.) 3x 6y 8z + 6 = 0
(i.e.) x 4y + 6z + 4 = 0
3x 6y + 8z + 6 = 0, 2x 3y + 7z + 4 = 0.
The radical centre is the point of intersection of the above two lines. So we
have to solve the equations
728
Example 14.34
Find the equation of the sphere through the origin and coaxal with the
spheres x2 + y2 + z2 = 1 and x2+ y2 + z2 + x + 2y + 3z 5 = 0.
Solution
The radical plane of the two given spheres is S S1 = 0.
(i.e.) x + 2y + 3z 4 = 0
(i.e.) x2 + y2 + z2 1 + (x + 2y + 3z 4) = 0
729
(x + 2y
Example 14.35
Find the limiting points of the coaxal system of spheres determined
by x2 + y2 + z2 + 4x 2y + 2z + 6 = 0 and x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x 4y 2z + 6 = 0.
Solution
The radical plane of the two given spheres is 2x + 2y + 4z = 0.
The equation to any sphere of the coaxal system is x2 + y2 + z2 + 4x 2y +
2z + 6 + (x + y + 2z) = 0.
The centre is
Radius is
For limiting point of the coaxal system radius = 0.
Therefore, the limiting points are the centres of point spheres of the coaxal
system.
Therefore, the limiting points are (2, 1, 1) and (1, 2, 1).
Example 14.36
730
(i.e.) x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x 4y 2z + 6 = 0
731
C1(0, 0, 0), r1 = 5
Therefore, the point of contact divides the lines of centres in the ratio 4:1
Therefore, the coordinates of the point of contact is
Exercises 1
1. Find the equation of the sphere with
732
2. Find the coordinates of the centre and radius of the following spheres:
0.
1.
2.
x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x 4y 6z + 15 = 0
2x2 + 2y2 + 2z2 2x 4y 6z 1 = 0
ax2 + ay2 + az2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0
3. Find the equation of the sphere whose centre is at the point (1, 2, 3) and which
passes through the point (3, 1, 2).
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x 4y 6z + 8 = 0
0.
1.
2.
3.
5. Find the equation of the sphere on the line joining the points (2, 3, 1) and (1,
2, 1) at the ends of a diameter.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 3x + 5y + 7 = 0
Ans.:
units
7. Find the equation of the sphere passing through the points (0, 2, 3), (1, 1, 1),
(5, 4, 2) and having its centre on the plane 3x + 4y + 2z 6 = 0.
733
8. Prove that a sphere can be made to pass through the midpoints of the edges of
a tetrahedron whose faces are x = 0, y = 0, z = 0 and
equation.
. Find its
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 ax by cz = 0
10. Prove that the sphere circumscribing the tetrahedron whose faces are y + z =
0, z + x = 0, x + y= 0 and x + y + z = 1 is x2 + y2 + z2 3(x + y + z) = 0.
11. A point moves such that, the sum of the squares of its distances from the six
faces of a cube is a constant. Prove that its locus is the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 =
3(k2 a2).
12. Prove that the spheres x2 + y2 + z2 = 100 and x2 + y2 + z2 12x + 4y 6z + 40 =
0 touch internally and find the point of contact.
Ans.:
13. Prove that the spheres x2 + y2 + z2 = 25 and x2 + y2 + z2 24x 40y 18z + 225
= 0 touch externally. Find the point of contact.
Ans.:
14. Find the condition that the plane lx + my + nz = p to be a tangent to the
sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = r2.
15. Find the equation of the sphere which touches the coordinate planes and
whose centre lies in the first octant.
16. Find the equation of the sphere with centre at (1, 1, 2) and touching the plane
2x 2y + z = 3.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x + 2y + z + 5 = 0
734
17. Find the equation of the sphere which has the points (2, 7, 4) and (4, 5, 1) as
the extremities of a diameter.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 6x 12y + 5z + 47 = 0
18. Find the equation of the sphere which touches the three coordinate planes and
the plane 2x + y+ 2z = 6 and being in the first octant.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 6x 6y 6z + 18 = 0
19. A point P moves from two points A(1, 3, 4) and B(1, 2, 1) such that 3.PA =
2.PB. Show that the locus of P is the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 2x 4y 16z + 42 =
0. Show also that this sphere divides A and B internally and externally in the
ration 2:3.
20. A plane passes through a fixed point (a, b, c). Show that the locus of the foot of
the perpendicular to it from the origin is the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 ax by cz =
0.
21. A variable sphere passes through the origin O and meets the coordinate axes
in A, B and C so that the volume of the tetrahedron OABC is a constant. Find
the locus of the centre of the sphere.
Ans.: xyz = k2
22. Find the equation of the sphere on the line joining the points:
23. A plane passes through a fixed point (a, b, c) and cuts the axes in A, B and C.
Show that the locus of centre of the sphere ABC is
24. A sphere of constant radius 2k passes through the origin and meets the axes
in A, B andC._Prove that the locus of the centroid of ABC is 9(x2 + y2 + z2)
= a2.
25. The tangent plane at any point of the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = a2 meets the
coordinate axes at A, Band C. Find the locus of the point of intersection of the
planes drawn parallel to the coordinate planes through A, B and C.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 = a2
735
26. OA, OB and OC are three mutually perpendicular lines through the origin and
their direction cosines are l1, m, n; l2, m2, n2 and l3, m3, n3.
If OA = a, OB = b, OC = c then prove that the equation of the
sphere OABC is x2 + y2 + z2 x(al1 + bl2 + cl3) y(am1 + bm2 + cm3)
z(an1 +bn2 + cn3) = 0.
Exercises 2
1. Find the centre and radius of a section of the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = 1 by the
plane lx + my + nz = 1.
Ans.:
2. Find the equation of the sphere through the circle x2 + y2 + z2 = 5, x + 2y + 3z =
3 and the point (1, 2, 3).
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x 2y + 2z 2 = 0
4. Find the centre and radius of the circle in which the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = 25 is
cut by the plane 2x + y + 2z = 9.
Ans.:
7. Prove that the radius of the circle x2 + y2 + z2 + x + y + z = 4, x + y + z = 0 is 2.
8. Find the centre and radius of the circle x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x 2y 4z 19 = 0, x +
2y + 2z + 7 = 0.
Ans.:
736
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 5x 6y + 7z 8 = 0
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x 2y 2z 6 = 0
Ans.:
13. Find the equation of the sphere which has its centre on the plane 5x + y 4z +
3 = 0 and passing through the circle x2 + y2 + z2 3x + 4y 2z + 8 = 0, 4x
5y + 3z 3 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 9x 11y + 7z 1 = 0
14. Find the equation of the sphere having the circle x2 + y2 + z2 + 10x 4z 8 =
0, x + y + z 3 = 0 as a great circle.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 6x 4y 3z + 4 = 0
surface
16. Find the equation of the spheres which pass through the circle x2 + y2 + z2
4x y + 6z + 12 = 0, 2x + 3y 7z = 10 and touch the plane x 2y 2z = 1.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x + 2y 4z + 2 = 0
x2 + y2 + z2 6x 4y + 10z + 22 = 0
17. Find the equation of the sphere which pass through the circle x2 + y2 + z2 =
5, x + 2y + 3z = 5 and touch the plane z = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x + y + 5z + 5 = 0
5(x2 + y2 + z2) (2x 4y + 5z + 1 = 0)
737
19. Find the equation of the sphere which passes through the point (3, 1, 2) and
meets XOY plane in a circle of radius 3 units with the centre at the point (1, 2,
0).
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x + 4y 4z 4 = 0
20. Find the centre and radius of the circle x2 + y2 + z2 + 12x 12y 16z + 111 = 0,
2x + 2y + z = 17.
Ans.:
22. Find the centre and radius of the circle x2 + y2 + z2 = 9, x + y + z = 1.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x 10z 9 = 0
25. Find the equation of the sphere passing through the circle x2 + y2 = a2, z = 0
and the point (, ,).
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x + 4y 6z + 5 = 0
738
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x 4y 5z + 5 = 0
5(x2 + y2 + z2) 2x 4y 5z + 1 = 0
28. Find the equation of the sphere having the circle x2 + y2 + z2 + 10y 4z 8 =
0, x + y + 23 = 0 as a great circle.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 4x + 6y 8z + 4 = 0
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 3x 4y + 5z 6 = 0
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x 2y 2z 6 = 0
31. Find the conditions that the circles x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d =
0, lx + my + nz = p and (x2 + y2 + z2) 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d =
0, lx + my + nz = p to lie on the same circle.
32. Find the centre and radius of the circle formed by the intersection of the
sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = 2225 and the plane 2x 2y + z = 27.
34. Find the equation of the circle which lies on the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = 25 and has
the centre at (1, 2, 3).
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 = 25, x + 2y + 3z = 14
739
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x + y 2z 1 = 0
38. Show that the two circles 2(x2 + y2 + z2) + 8x 13y + 17z 17 = 0, 2x + y 3z +
1 = 0 and x2 +y2 + z2 + 3x 4y + 3z = 0, x y + 2z 4 = 0 lie on the same
sphere and find its equation.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 5x 6y 7z 8 = 0
39. Find the equation of the sphere which has its centre on the plane 5x + y 4z +
3 = 0 and passing through the circle x2 + y2 + z2 3x + 4y 2z + 8 = 0, 4x
5y + 3z 3 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 9x 11y + 7z 1 = 0
40. Find the equation of the sphere which has the circle S = x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x + 4y +
6z 11 = 0, 2x+ y + 2z + 1 = 0 as great circle.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x + 2y + 2z 13 = 0.
41. Find the equation of the sphere whose radius is 1 and which passes through the
circle of intersection of the spheres x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x + 2y + 2z 6 = 0
and x2 + y2 + z2 + 3x + 3y z 1 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 6z 4 = 0
740
46. Find the equation of the circle circumscribing the triangle formed by the three
points (a, 0, 0), (0, b, 0), (0, 0, c). Obtain the coordinates of the centre of the
circle.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 x 2y 3z = 0, 6x 3y 2z 6 = 0
Centre =
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 7y 8z + 24 = 0
48. Find the equation of the sphere having its centre on the plane 4x 5y z 3 =
0 and passing through the circle x2 + y2 + z2 2x 3y + 4z + 8 =
0, x2 + y2 + z2 + 4x + 5y 6z + 2 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 7x + 9y 11z 1 = 0
49. A circle with centre (2, 3, 0) and radius unity is drawn on the plane z = 0. Find
the equation of the sphere which passes through the circle and the point (1, 1,
1).
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 4x 6y 6z + 12 = 0
50. Find the equation of the sphere which passes through the circle x2 + y2 = 4, z =
0 and is cut by the plane x + 2y + 2z = 0 in a circle of radius 3.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 6z 4 = 0,
x2 + y2 + z2 6z 4 = 0
741
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x 2y + 2z + 2 = 0
52. Find the equation of the sphere having the circle x2 + y2 + z2 + 10y 4z 3 =
0, x + y + z 3 = 0 as a great circle.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 4x + 6y 8z + 4 = 0
53. P is a variable point on a given line and A, B and C are projections on the axes.
Show that the sphere OABC passes through a fixed circle.
Exercises 3
1. Find the equations of the spheres which pass through the circle x2 + y2 + z2 =
5, x + 2y + 3z = 5 and touch the plane z = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x + y + 5z + 5 = 0
5(x2 + y2 + z2) 2x 4y + 5z + 1 = 0
2. Find the equations of the spheres which pass through the circle x2 + y2 + z2
4x y + 3z + 12 = 0, 2x + 3y 8z = 10 and touch the plane x 2y 2z = 1.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 2x + 2y 4z + 2 = 0
x2 + y2 + z2 6x 4y + 10z + 22 = 0
Ans.: (3, 4, 2)
742
7. Find the equation of the tangent plane at the origin to the sphere x2 + y2 + z2
8x 6y + 4z = 0.
Ans.: 4x 3y + 2z = 0
Ans.: 8x 4y + z 34 = 0, 4x 2y z 16 = 0
Ans.: 2x 2y + z = 9
12. Find the value of k for which the plane x + y + z = k touches the
sphere x2 + y2 + z2 2x 4y 6z + 11 = 0. Find the point of contact in each
case.
Ans.: x + 2y + 2z 23 = 0
x + 2y + 2z 1 = 0
743
Ans.: (5, 3, 3)
16. Tangent planes at any point of the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = r2 meets the coordinate
axes at A, B andC. Show that the locus of the point of intersection of the planes
drawn parallel to the coordinate planes through the points A, B and C is the
surface x2 + y2 + z2 = r2.
17. Find the condition that the line
where l, m and n are the
direction cosines of a line, should touch the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 + 2ux + 2vy +
2wz + d = 0. Show that there are two spheres through the points (0, 0, 0), (2a,
0, 0), (0, 2b, 0) and (0, 0, 2c) which touch the above line and that the distance
between their centres is
18. Find the equation of the sphere which touches the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 + 3y x +
2z 3 = 0 at (1, 1, 1) and passes through the origin.
19. Find the equation of the tangent line in symmetrical form to the
circle x2 + y2 + z2 + 5x 7y + 2z 8 = 0, 3x 2y + 4z + 3 = 0.
Ans.: (1, 4, 2)
21. Find the equation of the sphere which touches the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x
6y + 1 = 0 at the point (1, 2, 2) and passes through the origin.
22. Find the equations of the spheres which pass through the circle x2 + y2 + z2 = 1,
2x + 4y + 5z 6 = 0 and touch the plane z = 0.
23. Find the equations of the sphere passing through the circle x2 + y2 + z2 5 = 0,
2x + 3y + z 3 = 0 and touching the plane 3x + 4z 15 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 4x + 6y 2z 11 = 0
5(x2 + y2 + z2) 8x 12y 4z 37 = 0
744
24. Find the point of intersection of the line and the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 4x + 6y
2z + 5 = 0.
25. Prove that the sum of the squares of the intercepts made by a given line on any
three mutually perpendicular lines through a fixed point is constant.
Exercises 4
1. Prove that the spheres x2 + y2 + z2 + 6y + 2z + 8 = 0 and x2 + y2 + z2 + 6x + 8y +
4z + 2 = 0 intersect orthogonally.
2. Find the equation of the sphere which passes through the circle x2 + y2 + z2
2x + 3y 4z + 6 = 0, 3x 4y + 5z 15 = 0 and which cuts orthogonally the
sphere x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x + 4y 6z + 11 = 0.
3. Find the equation of the sphere that passes through the circle x2 + y2 + z2 2x +
3y 4z + 6 = 0, 3x 4y + 5z 15 = 0 and which cuts the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 +
2x + 4y + 6z + 11 = 0 orthogonally.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + x y + z 9 = 0
6. Find the equation of the sphere that passes through the points (a, b, c) and (2,
1, 4) and cuts orthogonally the two spheres x2 + y2 + z2 + x 3y + 2 = 0 and
(x2 + y2 + z2) + x + 3y + 4 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 2x 2y + 4z 3 = 0
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 7x + 10y 5z + 12 = 0
745
8. If d is the distance between the centres of the two spheres of radii r1 and r2 then
prove that the angle between them is
9. Find the condition that the sphere a(x2 + y2 + z2) + 2lx + z y + 2nz + p = 0
and b(x2 + y2 +z2)k2 may cut orthogonally.
Ans.: x y + z 1 = 0, 3x 6y + 8z 6 = 0
x 4y + 6z + 4 = 0
11. Find the equation of the radical line of the spheres (x 2)2 + y2 + z2 = 1, x2 +
(y 3)2 + z2 = 6 and (x + 2)2 + (y + 1)2 + (z 2)2 = 6.
Ans.: x y + z + 1 = 0, 3x 6y + 8z + 6 = 0
Ans.: 2x y z 3 = 0
15. Find the limiting points of the coaxal system defined by the
spheres x2 + y2 + z2 + 3x 3y + 6 = 0, x2 + y2 + z2 6y 6z + 6 = 0.
16. Find the limiting points of the coaxal system determined by the two spheres
whose equations are x2 + y2 + z2 8x + 2y 2z + 32 = 0, x2 + y2 + z2 7x + z +
23 = 0.
746
17. Find the equations of the spheres whose limiting points are (1, 2, 1) and (2,
1, 1) and which touches the plane 2x + 3y + 6z + 7 = 0.
18. Find the equation of the sphere which touches the plane 3x + 2y z + 2 = 0 at
the point (1, 2, 1) and also cut orthogonally the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 4x + 6y +
4 = 0.
Ans.: x2 + y2 + z2 + 7x + 10y 5z + 12 = 0
19. Find the limiting points of the coaxal system two of whose members
are x2 + y2 + z2 3x 3y + 6 = 0, x2 + y2 + z2 4y 6z + 6 = 0.
20. The point (1, 2, 1) is a limiting point of a coaxal system of spheres of which the
sphere x2 + y2 +z2 + 3x 2y + 6 = 0 is a member. Find the coordinates of the
other limiting point.
Ans.: (2, 1, 1)
747
Chapter 15
Cone
15.1 DEFINITION OF CONE
Let (, , ) be the given vertex and ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0, z =
0 be the guiding curve.
The equations of any line passing through the point (, , ) are
This point lies on the given curve ax2 + 2hxy + by2 + 2gx + 2fy + c = 0, z =
0.
Eliminating l, m, n from (15.1) and (15.2) we get the equation of the cone.
From (15.1)
748
749
or
750
To show that the equation of a cone with its vertex at the origin is
homogeneous, let
From equations (15.8) and (15.11), we observe that the equation f(x, y, z) =
0 is homogeneous.
Conversely, every homogeneous equation in (x, y, z) represents a cone with
its vertex at the origin.
Let f(x, y, z) = 0 be a homogeneous equation in x, y, z.
Since f(x, y, z) = 0 is a homogeneous equation, f(x, y, z) = 0 for any real
number. In particular f(0, 0, 0) = 0.
751
Therefore, the origin lies on the locus of the equation (15.8). As f(tx, ty, tz)
= 0, any point on the line through the origin lies on the equation (15.8). In
other words, the locus of (15.8) is a surface generated by the line through
the origin. Hence equation represents a cone with its vertex at the origin.
Note 15.3.1: If f(x, y, z) can be expressed as the product of n linear factors
then f(x, y, z) = 0 represents n planes through the origin.
Note 15.3.2: If f(x, y, z) = 0 is a homogeneous equation of second degree
in x, y and z then f(x, y, z) = 0 is a quadric cone. If it can be factored into
two linear factors then it represents a pair of planes through the origin;
then we regard equation f(x, y, z) = 0 as degenerate cone, the vertex being
any point on the line of intersection of the two planes.
Generators: The line
is a generator of the cone f(x, y, z) = 0 with
its vertex at the origin if and only if f(l, m, n) = 0.
Let
be a generator of the cone f(x, y, z) = 0 then the point (lr,
mr, nr) lies on the cone. Taking r = 1, the point (l, m, n) lies on the cone f(x,
y, z) = 0.
f(l, m, n) = 0
Converse: Let f(x, y, z) = 0 be the equation of the cone with its vertex at
the origin and
= 0.
752
Example 15.3.1
Find the equation of the cone with its vertex at the origin and which passes
through the curve ax2 +by2 + cz2 1 = 0 = x2 + y2 2z.
Solution
Let the equation of the generator be
Any point on this line is (lr, mr, nr). This point lies on the curve
From (15.14),
753
Find the equation of the cone whose vertex is at the origin and the guiding
curve is
Solution
Since the vertex of the cone is the origin its equation must be a
homogeneous equation of second degree.
The equations of the guiding curve are
Homogenizing the equation (15.15) with the help of (15.16) we get the
equation of the required cone. Hence the equation of the cone
is
Example 15.3.3
The plane
meets the coordinate axes at A, B and C. Prove that the
equation of the cone generated by lines drawn from O to meet the
circle ABC is
Solution
The points A, B, C are (a, 0, 0), (0, b, 0) and (0, 0, c), respectively.
The equation of the sphere OABC is x2 + y2 + z2 ax by cz = 0.
The equations of the circle ABC are
754
Homogenizing equation (15.17) with the help of (15.18) we get the equation
of the required cone.
Let (x1, y1, z1) be the vertex of the cone. Shift the origin to the point (x1, y1, z1).
Then
755
Solving any three of these four equations, we get the vertex of the cone. Test
whether these values ofx, y, z satisfy the fourth equation.
Example 15.4.1
Find the equation of the cone of the second degree which passes through
the axes.
Solution
756
The cone passes through the axes. Therefore, the vertex of the cone is the
origin.
The equations of the cone is a homogeneous equation of second degree in x,
y and z.
a=0
where
757
we get,
Example 15.4.3
Find the equation to the quadric cone which passes through the three
coordinate axes and the three mutually perpendicular lines
,
Solution
We have seen that the equation of the cone passing through the axes is
or
we have
758
759
1. Find the equation of the cone whose vertex is at the origin and which passes
through the curve of intersection of the plane lx + my + nz = p and the
surface, ax2 + by2 + cz2 = 1.
2. Find the equation of the cone whose vertex is (, , ) and whose guiding curve
is the parabolay2 = 4ax, z = 0.
5. Find the equation of the cone whose vertex is the point (0, 0, 1) and whose
guiding curve is the ellipse
, z = 3. Also obtain section of the cone by
the plane y = 0 and identify its type.
6. Find the equations of the cones with vertex at the origin and passing through
the curves of intersection given by the equations:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
760
7. The plane x + y + z = 1 meets the coordinate axes in A, B and C. Prove that the
equation to the cone generated by the lines through O, to meet the
circle ABC is yz + zx + xy = 0.
8. A variable plane is parallel to the plane
B and C. Prove that, the circle ABC lies on the
cone
9.
0.
1.
where f(x,
10. Find the equation to the cone whose vertex is the origin and the base
circle x = a, y2 + z2 = b2and show that the section of the cone by a plane parallel
to the xy-plane is hyperbola.
11. Planes through OX and OY include an angle . Show that the line of
intersection lies on the conez2(x2 + y2 + z2) = x2y2 tan2 .
12. Prove that a cone of second degree can be found to pass through two sets of
rectangular axes through the same origin.
13. Prove that the equation x2 2y2 + 3z2 + 5yz 6zx 4xy + 8x 19y 2z 20 =
0 represents a cone with its vertex at (1, 2, 3).
14. Prove that the equation 2y2 8yz 4zx 8xy + 6x 4y 2z + 5 = 0 represents
a cone whose vertex is
761
15. Prove that the equation ax2 + by2 + cz2 + 2ux + 2vy + 2wz + d = 0 represents a
cone if
15.5 RIGHT CIRCULAR CONE
762
Note 15.5.1.1:
1. If the vertex is at the origin then the equation of the cone becomes (lx + my +
nz)2 = [(x2 + y2 +z2)(l2 + m2 + n2)]cos2.
2. If l, m, n are the direction cosines of the line then
3. If axis of cone is the z-axis then the equation (15.33) becomes
or
Let P(x, y, z) be any point on the tangent drawn from V(x1, y1, z1) to the
given sphere. Let Q be the point that divides PQ in the ratio 1:. Then the
coordinates of Q are
763
Example 15.5.1
Find the equation of the right circular cone whose vertex is at the origin,
whose axis is the line
Solution
The axis of the cone is
764
Example 15.5.2
Find the equation of the right circular cone with its vertex at the origin, axis
along the z-axis and semi-vertical angle .
765
Solution
The direction cosines of the axis of the cone are 0, 0, 1.
Let P(x, y, z) be any point on the cone.
Then,
This is the required equation of the cone.
Example 15.5.3
Find the semi-vertical angle and the equation of the right circular cone
having its vertex at origin and passing through the circle y2 + z2 = b2, x = a.
Solution
The guiding circle of the right circular cone is y2 + z2 = b2, x = a.
Therefore, the axis of the cone is along x-axis.
If is the semi-vertical angle, then
766
767
Squaring, cross multiplying and simplifying we get, 5x2 + 5y2 + 5z2 8xy
8yz 8zx 4x + 86y 58z + 278 = 0.
Example 15.5.5
A right circular cone has three mutually perpendicular generators. Prove
that the semi-vertical angle of the cone is
Solution
The equation of the right circular cone with vertex at the origin, semivertical angle and axis alongz-axis is given by x2 + y2 = z2 tan2.
768
Example 15.5.6
The axis of a right cone vertex O, makes equal angles with the coordinate
axes and the cone passes through the line drawn from O with direction
cosines proportional to (1, 2, 2). Find the equation to the cone.
Solution
Let the axis of the cone make an angle with the axes. Then the direction
cosines of the axes are cos, cos , cos . (i.e.) 1, 1, 1.
Let be the semi-vertical angle of the axis of the cone.
The direction ratios of one of the generators are 1, 2, 2.
769
9(x + y + z)2 = x2 + y2 + z2
Example 15.5.8
Show that the plane z = 0 cuts the enveloping cone of the
sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = 11 which has its vertex at (2, 4, 1) in a rectangular
hyperbola.
Solution
The equation of the enveloping cone with its vertex at (2, 4, 1) is T2 = SS1.
770
2. If (x, y, z) is any point on the cone whose vertex is (1, 0, 2) and semi-vertical
angle is 30 and the equation to the axis is
, show that the
2
2
2
equation of the cone is 27[(x 1) + y + (z 2) ] = 4(x + 2y 2z + 3)2.
3. Find the equation to the right circular cone of semi-vertical angle 30, whose
vertex is (1, 2, 3) and whose axis is parallel to the line x = y = z.
4. Find the equation to the right circular cone whose vertex is (3, 2, 1),
semivertical angle is 30 and axis is the line
6. Find the equation of the right circular cone which passes through the three
lines drawn from the origin with direction ratios (1, 2, 2) (2, 1, 2) (2, 2, 1).
7. Lines are drawn through the origin with direction cosines proportional to (1, 2,
2), (2, 3, 6), (3, 4,12). Find the equation of the right circular cone through
them. Also find the semi-vertical angle of the cone.
771
Ans:
8. Find the equation of the cone generated when the straight line 2y + 3z = 6, x =
0 revolves about the z-axis.
9. Find the equation to the right circular cone which has the three coordinate axes
as generators.
Ans.: xy + yz + zx = 0
10. Find the equation of the right circular cone with its vertex at the point (0, 0, 0),
its axis along the y-axis and semi-vertical angle .
Ans.: x2 + z2 = y2 tan2
11. If is the semi-vertical angle of the right circular cone which passes through
the lines ox, oy, x= y = z, show that
12. Prove that x2 + y2 + z2 2x + 4y + 6z + 6 = 0 represents a right circular cone
whose vertex is the point (1, 2, 3), whose axis is parallel to oy and whose
semi-vertical angle is 45.
13. Prove that the semi-vertical angle of a right circular cone which has three
mutually perpendicular tangent planes is
14. Find the enveloping cone of the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 2x 2y = 2 with its vertex
at (1, 1, 1).
15. Find the enveloping cone of the sphere x2 + y2 + z2 = 11 which has its vertex at
(2, 4, 1) and show that the plane z = 0 cuts the enveloping cone in a rectangular
hyperbola.
15.6 TANGENT PLANE
Tangent plane from the point (x1, y1, z1) to the cone ax2 + by2 + cz2 + 2fyz +
2gzx + 2hxy = 0.
The equations of any line through the point (x1, y1, z1) are
772
This equation is a quadratic in r. Since (x1, y1, z1) is a point on the cone
Hence this is the condition for the line (15.35) to be a tangent to the curve
at the point (x1, y1, z1).
Since equation (15.38) can be satisfied for infinitely many values of l, m,
n there are infinitely many tangent lines at any point of the cone.
The locus of all such tangent lines is obtained by eliminating l, m,
n from (15.35) and (15.38).
773
Note 15.6.1: (0, 0, 0) satisfies the above equation and hence the tangent
plane at any point of a cone passes through the vertex.
The tangent plane at any point of a cone touches the cone along
the generator throughP.
Proof:
Let the equation of the cone be ax2 + by2 + cz2 + 2fyz + 2gzx + 2hxy = 0.
Let P(x1, y1, z1) be any point on the cone.
The equation of the tangent plane at P is (ax1 + hy1 + gz1)x +
(hx1 + by1 + fz1)y + (gx1 + fy1 + cz1)z = 0.
The equations of the generator through P are
Any point on this line is (rx1, ry1, rz1). The equation of the tangent plane at
(rx1, ry1, rz1) is (arx1 +hry1 + grz1)x + (hrx1 + bry1 + frz1)y +
(grx1 + fry1 + crz1)z = 0.
Dividing by r,
(ax1 + hy1 + gz1)x + (hx1 + by1 + fz1)y + (gx1 + fy1 + cz1)z = 0 which is also the
equation of the tangent plane at (x1, y1, z1). Therefore, the tangent plane
at P touches the cone along the generator through P.
15.6.1 Condition for the Tangency of a Plane and a Cone
Let the equation of the cone be
Let the plane (15.40) touch the cone at (x1, y1, z1).
The equation of the tangent plane at (x1, y1, z1) is
774
Eliminating (x1, y1, z1), r1 from (15.43), (15.44), (15.45) and (15.46) we get,
Hence (15.47) is the required condition for the plane (15.40) to touch the
cone.
15.7 RECIPROCAL CONE
775
Let us now find the equation of the cone reciprocal to the cone
The equation of the line through the vertex (0, 0, 0) of the cone (15.48) and
normal to the tangent plane (15.49) are
776
from (15.56)
Substituting this in (15.55) we get,
Also since
777
778
779
We have seen that the condition for the plane ux + vy + wz = 0 cut the cone
in two perpendicular generators is that
780
As this line lies on the plane and also on the cone we get
From (15.62)
m = (3l + 5n)
Therefore, the direction ratios of the two lines are 1, 2, 1 and 2,1, 1.
If is the angle between the lines
Therefore, the acute angle between the lines is
Example 15.7.2
Prove that the angle between the lines given by x + y + z = 0, ayz + bzx +
cxy = 0 is
Solution
if a + b + c = 0.
781
The plane
If l1, m1, n1 and l2, m2, n2 are the direction ratios of the two lines we get,
782
Example 15.7.3
Prove that the cones ax2 + by2 + cz2 = 0 and
are reciprocal.
Solution
The equation of the reciprocal cone ax2 + by2 + cz2 = 0 is
783
Solution
1. x + 3y 2z = 0, x2 + 9y2 4z2 = 0
2. 6x 10y 7z = 0, 108x2 20y2 7z2 = 0
Ans:
2. Show that the angle between the lines in which the plane x + y + z = 0 cuts the
cone ayz + bzx + cxy = 0 is
3. Prove that the equation a2x2 + b2y2 + c2z2 2bcyz 2cazx 2abxy = 0
represents a cone which touches the coordinate plane.
4. If
represents one of the generators of the three mutually perpendicular
generators of the cone 5yz 8zx 3xy = 0 then find the other two.
784
Ans:
5. If
represents one of the three mutually perpendicular generators of the
cone 11yz + 6zx 14xy = 0 then find the other two.
Ans:
785
Chapter 16
Cylinder
16.1 DEFINITION
Let us find the equation of the cylinder whose generators are parallel to the
line
Let us find the point where this line meets the plane z = 0. When z =
0,
This point is
786
When the generator meets the conic, this point lies on the conic.
The locus of the tangent lines drawn to a sphere and parallel to a given line
Let the given sphere be
787
The locus (, , ) is
788
Let P (x, y, z) be any point on the cylinder. Let AA be the axis of the
cylinder.
Draw PL perpendicular to the axis and PL = a.
Let Q(, , ) be a point on the axis of the cylinder.
789
Example 16.1
Find the equation of the cylinder whose generators are parallel to the
line
Solution
Let P(x, y, z) be a point on the cylinder.
are
790
Since the generators are parallel to z-axis the equation of the cylinder is of
the form f (x, y) = 0.
The equation of the cylinder is obtained by eliminating z in equation (16.10)
791
Let (x1, y1, z1) be a point on the cylinder. Then the equations of the generator
through P(x1, y1, z1) are
When this line meets the plane z = 3, we have,
Example 16.4
Find the equation of the surface generated by the straight line y = mx, z =
nx and intersecting the ellipse
Solution
The given line y = mx, z = nx can be expressed in symmetrical form as
792
793
794
795
796
Example 16.8
Find the equation of the cylinder whose generators have direction cosines l,
m, n and which passes through the circle x2 + z2 = a2, y = 0.
Solution
797
Solution
The equations of the axis of the cylinder are
798
799
800
801
802
803
If equation (16.22) touches the sphere of equation (16.23), then the two
values of r of this equation are equal.
804
805
Answers
1. 10x2 + 5y2 + 13z2 + 12xy + 4xz + 6yz 36x 30y 18z + 36 = 0
2. 3x2 + 6y2 + 3z2 2xz + 8yz 3 = 0
4. 9x2 + 9y2 + 5z2 6xz 12yz 144 = 0
5. 3x2 + 3y2 + 4xy 4x 4y 10 = 0
7. 36x2 + 9y2 + 17z2 + 6yz 48xz 9 = 0
9. 5x2 + 8y2 + 5z2 4yz 8zx 4xy + 22x 16y 14z 10 = 0
10. 45x2 + 40y2 + 13z2 + 36yz 24zx + 12xy 42x 280y 126z + 294 = 0
11. 10x2 + 5y2 + 13z2 12xy 6yz 4zx 8x + 30y 74z + 59 = 0
12. 27x2 + 36y2 + 112z2 36xz 120yz 180 = 0
13. 5x2 + 8y2 + 5z2 4xy + 4yz + 8zx 144 = 0
14.
15. x2 + y2 + z2 xy yz zx 4x + 5y z 2 = 0
16. 5x2 + 8y2 + 8z2 + 4xy + 2yz 4xz + 4x 18y 36z = 99
17. (l2 + m2 + n2)[(x a)2 + (y b)2 + (z c)2 r2]
= [l(x a) + m(y b) + n(z c)]2
806
Acknowledgements
I express my sincere thanks to Pearson Education, India, especially to K.
Srinivas, Sojan, Charles, and Ramesh for their constant encouragement and
for successfully bringing out this book.
P. R. Vittal
807
808